xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-4.7/gcc/doc/tm.texi (revision c6f73aab)
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints::     The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs::             Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses::  Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC::                 Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point::      Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS::        Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors::   MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target::          Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI::             Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc::                Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''.  This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''.  This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself.  It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands.  It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones.  It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options.  It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver.  It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default.  This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target.  The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified.  The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper).  This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments.  If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}.  On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead.  @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.  If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
393removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394@end defmac
395
396@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
398@end deftypevr
399
400@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
401Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
402string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
403target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
404@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
405
406Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
407the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
408@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
409@xref{Target Fragment}.
410@end defmac
411
412@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
413Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
414a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
415indicates an absolute file name.
416@end defmac
417
418@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
419If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
420@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
421when the compiler is built as a cross
422compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
423to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
424@end defmac
425
426@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
427Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
429try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
431is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
437when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
439is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
442@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
443Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
444standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
445default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
446@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
447is built as a cross compiler.
448@end defmac
449
450@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
451If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
452standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
453compiler is built as a cross compiler.
454@end defmac
455
456@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
457If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
458standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
459cross compiler.
460@end defmac
461
462@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
463Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
464variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
465loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
466initialize the necessary environment variables.
467@end defmac
468
469@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
470Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
471standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
472try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
473comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
474@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
475
476Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
477replacement.
478@end defmac
479
480@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
481The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
482See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
483If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
484@end defmac
485
486@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
487Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
488for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
489usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
490@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
491@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
492and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
493and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
494@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
495
496The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
497Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
498string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
499for C++-only directories,
500and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
501wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
502the array with a null element.
503
504The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
505if any, in all uppercase letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
506or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
507operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
508
509For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
510
511@smallexample
512#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
513@{                                       \
514  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
515  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
516  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
517  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
518  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
519@}
520@end smallexample
521@end defmac
522
523Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
524
525@enumerate
526@item
527Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
528
529@item
530The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
531is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
532@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
533
534@item
535The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
536
537@item
538The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
539in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
540
541@item
542The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544@item
545The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
546
547@item
548The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
549compiler.
550@end enumerate
551
552Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
553
554@enumerate
555@item
556Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
557
558@item
559The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
560value based on the installed toolchain location.
561
562@item
563The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
564(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
565
566@item
567The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
568in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
569
570@item
571The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
572
573@item
574The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
575compiler.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
579native compiler, or we have a target system root.
580
581@item
582The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
583native compiler, or we have a target system root.
584
585@item
586The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
587If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
588the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
589
590@item
591The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
592compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
593@file{/lib/}.
594
595@item
596The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
597compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
598@file{/usr/lib/}.
599@end enumerate
600
601@node Run-time Target
602@section Run-time Target Specification
603@cindex run-time target specification
604@cindex predefined macros
605@cindex target specifications
606
607@c prevent bad page break with this line
608Here are run-time target specifications.
609
610@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
611This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
612built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
613the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
614@code{builtin_assert}.  When the front end
615calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
616finished command line option processing your code can use those
617results freely.
618
619@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
620command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
621the assertion.  @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
622accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
623
624@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
625object-like macro.  If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
626@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally.  Otherwise, it
627defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
628with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
629only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line.  For
630example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
631and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
632@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
633defines only @code{_ABI64}.
634
635You can also test for the C dialect being compiled.  The variable
636@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
637or @code{clk_objective_c}.  Note that if we are preprocessing
638assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
639macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
640to check for that first.  If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
641variable @code{flag_iso} can be used.  The function-like macro
642@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
643preprocessing.
644@end defmac
645
646@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
647Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
648and is used for the target operating system instead.
649@end defmac
650
651@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
652Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
653and is used for the target object format.  @file{elfos.h} uses this
654macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
655it yourself.
656@end defmac
657
658@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
659This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
660any target-specific headers.
661@end deftypevar
662
663@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
664This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
665Its default setting is 0.
666@end deftypevr
667
668@cindex optional hardware or system features
669@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
670
671@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
672This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
673target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
674(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
675processing and should return true if the option is valid.  The default
676definition does nothing but return true.
677
678@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments.  @var{opts} and
679@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
680storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
681option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
682via attributes).
683@end deftypefn
684
685@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
686This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
687target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
688definition files(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some
689option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
690valid.  The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}.  The
691default definition does nothing but return false.
692
693In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
694options.  However, if processing an option requires routines that are
695only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
696should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
697@end deftypefn
698
699@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
700Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
701@end deftypefn
702
703@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
704Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced  by the current TU.
705@end deftypefn
706
707@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
708Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined  by the current TU.
709@end deftypefn
710
711@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
712If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
713@end deftypefn
714
715@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
716If a target implements string objects then this hook should should  provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list}  against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of  @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
717@end deftypefn
718
719@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
720This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
721but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
722pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
723attribute or pragma.  It is not called at the beginning of compilation
724when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
725actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
726@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
727@end deftypefn
728
729@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
730This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
731but is only used in the C
732language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
733used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
734frontends.
735@end defmac
736
737@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
738Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
739various optimization levels.   This variable, if defined, describes
740options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels.  These
741options are processed once
742just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
743of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
744options passed explicitly.
745
746This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
747options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
748@code{optimize} attribute.
749@end deftypevr
750
751@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
752Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
753@end deftypefn
754
755@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
756Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
757@end deftypefn
758
759@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
760Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
761during compilation.  For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
762the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16.  Source code
763can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
764and @code{nomips16} attributes.
765
766Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
767registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
768operations, and so on.  GCC caches a lot of this type of information
769in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
770significant amount of time.  The compiler therefore provides a facility
771for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
772switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
773
774Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility.  The default
775is 0.
776@end defmac
777
778@node Per-Function Data
779@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
780@cindex per-function data
781@cindex data structures
782
783If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
784provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
785using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
786nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
787when another one comes along.
788
789GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
790contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
791structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
792@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
793to their own specific data.
794
795If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
796@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
797This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
798@code{init_machine_status}.  This pointer is explained below.
799
800One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
801RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
802RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
803function, for level 0.
804
805Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
806all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
807function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
808stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
809stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
810@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
811the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
812single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
813longer supported.
814
815@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
816Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
817is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
818The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
819function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
820@end defmac
821
822@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
823If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
824function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
825target to perform any target specific initialization of the
826@code{struct function} structure.  It is intended that this would be
827used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
828
829@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
830Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
831GC allocation, including the structure itself.
832@end deftypevar
833
834@node Storage Layout
835@section Storage Layout
836@cindex storage layout
837
838Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
839alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
840expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
841@xref{Run-time Target}.
842
843@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
844Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
845byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
846This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
847bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
848be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
849macro need not be a constant.
850
851This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
852bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
853@end defmac
854
855@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
856Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
857word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
858@end defmac
859
860@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
861Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
862most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
863memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
864order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers.  This
865macro need not be a constant.
866@end defmac
867
868@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
869On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
870registers in memory.  In such a situation, define this macro to describe
871the order of words in a register.  The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
872the order of words in memory.
873@end defmac
874
875@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
876Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
877@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
878containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
879have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
880
881You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
882multi-word integers.
883@end defmac
884
885@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
886Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
887unit (byte).  If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
888@end defmac
889
890@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
891Number of bits in a word.  If you do not define this macro, the default
892is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
893@end defmac
894
895@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
896Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
897@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
898largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
899@end defmac
900
901@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
902Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
903register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
904@end defmac
905
906@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
907Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
908@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
909smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
910@end defmac
911
912@defmac POINTER_SIZE
913Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
914width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
915you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.  If you do not specify
916a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
917@end defmac
918
919@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
920A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
921@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}.  It is
922greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
923should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
924is needed.  In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
925@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
926
927You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
928and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
929@end defmac
930
931@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
932A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
933is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
934stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
935scalar type.
936
937On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
938register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
939@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
940cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
941floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
942counterparts.
943
944For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
945However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
946either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
947the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
948sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
949@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
950
951Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
952@end defmac
953
954@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
955Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
956function return values.  The target hook should return the new mode
957and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
958change signedness.  This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
959pointer} types.
960
961@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
962return values.  If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
963@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
964If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
965which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
966then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
967the signedness may be different.
968
969@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
970
971The default is to not promote arguments and return values.  You can
972also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
973if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
974@end deftypefn
975
976@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
977Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
978bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
979regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
980size of an integer.
981@end defmac
982
983@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
984Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
985stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
986desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
987if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
988this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
989@end defmac
990
991@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
992Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
993stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
994is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
995macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
996@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997@end defmac
998
999@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1000Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1001from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.  This macro must evaluate
1002to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1006Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1007@end defmac
1008
1009@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1010Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1011bits.  Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1012just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1013@end defmac
1014
1015@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1016Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1017provide.  If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1018@end defmac
1019
1020@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1021Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct.  If
1022not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1023@end defmac
1024
1025@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1026If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1027object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1028nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1029on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1030@end defmac
1031
1032@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1033Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1034machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1035structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1036by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1037@end defmac
1038
1039@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1040An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1041alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1042@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1043alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1044field alignment has not been set by the
1045@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1046@end defmac
1047
1048@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1049Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend.  Use this macro
1050to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1051
1052If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1053
1054@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1055@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1056@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1057@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1058@end defmac
1059
1060@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1061Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1062Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1063@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1064the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1065
1066On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1067the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1068a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1069On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1070@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1071@end defmac
1072
1073@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1074If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1075the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1076the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1077macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1078
1079If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1080
1081@findex strcpy
1082One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1083make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1084arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1085constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1086@end defmac
1087
1088@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1089If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1090that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1091@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1092have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1093align the object.
1094
1095If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1096
1097The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1098constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1099constants can be done inline.
1100@end defmac
1101
1102@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1103If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1104the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1105the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1106macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1107
1108If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1109
1110One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1111make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1112
1113If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1114@end defmac
1115
1116@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1117This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1118@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI.  The default is to
1119require natural alignment for vector types.  The alignment returned by
1120this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1121the vector element type.
1122@end deftypefn
1123
1124@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1125If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1126@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1127and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1128have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1129align the slot.
1130
1131If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1132@var{type} is @code{NULL}.  Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1133be used.
1134
1135This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1136of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1137
1138If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1139@end defmac
1140
1141@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1142If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1143variable @var{decl}.
1144
1145If this macro is not defined, then
1146@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1147is used.
1148
1149One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1150make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1151
1152If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1153@end defmac
1154
1155@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1156If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1157for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1158@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1159
1160If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1161@end defmac
1162
1163@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1164Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1165empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1166
1167If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1168@end defmac
1169
1170@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1171Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1172Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1173
1174If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1175@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1176@end defmac
1177
1178@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1179Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1180if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1181go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1182@end defmac
1183
1184@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1185Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1186alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1187
1188The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1189@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1190structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1191that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1192that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1193
1194Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1195@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1196four-byte alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may
1197not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1198
1199An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1200structure.
1201
1202If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1203a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1204
1205Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1206bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1207support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1208@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1209
1210The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1211@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1212Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1213
1214Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1215@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1216@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1217
1218If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1219bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1220what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1221
1222@smallexample
1223struct foo1
1224@{
1225  char x;
1226  char :0;
1227  char y;
1228@};
1229
1230struct foo2
1231@{
1232  char x;
1233  int :0;
1234  char y;
1235@};
1236
1237main ()
1238@{
1239  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1240          sizeof (struct foo1));
1241  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1242          sizeof (struct foo2));
1243  exit (0);
1244@}
1245@end smallexample
1246
1247If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1248get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1249@end defmac
1250
1251@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1252Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1253to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1254@end defmac
1255
1256@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1257When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1258whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1259structure.  The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1260the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1261@end deftypefn
1262
1263@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1264This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1265should use the narrowest mode possible.  It should return @code{false} if
1266these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1267
1268The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1269@end deftypefn
1270
1271@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1272Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1273@code{BLKMODE}.
1274
1275If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1276mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode.  @var{mode} is provided in the
1277case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1278retain the field's mode.
1279
1280Normally, this is not needed.
1281@end defmac
1282
1283@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1284Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1285by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1286way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1287@var{specified}.
1288
1289The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1290the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1291@end defmac
1292
1293@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1294An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1295machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1296this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1297appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1298(DImode)} is assumed.
1299@end defmac
1300
1301@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1302If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1303specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1304@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1305@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1306@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1307having its mode specified.
1308
1309You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1310would most commonly define this macro if the
1311@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
131264-bit mode.
1313@end defmac
1314
1315@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1316If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1317specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1318@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1319
1320You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1321You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1322pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1323@end defmac
1324
1325@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1326This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1327of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1328@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1329targets.
1330@end deftypefn
1331
1332@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1333This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1334of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1335@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1336targets.
1337@end deftypefn
1338
1339@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1340Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1341The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1342@end deftypefn
1343
1344@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1345If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1346mode is towards zero.
1347
1348Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1349floating-point arithmetic.
1350
1351Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1352@end defmac
1353
1354@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1355This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1356bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1357exponent for normal numbers instead.
1358
1359Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1360floating-point arithmetic.
1361
1362The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1363@end defmac
1364
1365@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1366This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1367@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1368Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1369unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1370different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1371alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1372bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1373the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1374(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1375another bit-field of nonzero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1376other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1377
1378When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1379of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1380bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1381and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1382chunk of 32 bits.  However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1383size is allocated).  In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1384alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1385
1386If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1387the latter will take precedence.  If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1388used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1389precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1390may affect its placement.
1391@end deftypefn
1392
1393@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1394Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1395@end deftypefn
1396
1397@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1398Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1399@end deftypefn
1400
1401@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1402This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1403to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1404For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1405for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1406registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1407usage.
1408@end deftypefn
1409
1410@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1411This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1412that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1413@end deftypefn
1414
1415@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1416If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1417uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1418to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1419mangled name.  The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1420the type to be mangled.  The hook may be applied to trees which are
1421not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1422for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize.  If the
1423return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1424string constant.
1425
1426Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1427qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types.  Encode new
1428fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1429is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1430length of @var{name} in decimal.  Encode qualified versions of
1431ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1432@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1433@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1434code used to represent the unqualified version of this type.  (See
1435@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1436codes.)  In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1437spaces in your string.
1438
1439This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution.  If the mangled
1440name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1441can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1442before mangling.
1443
1444The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1445appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1446types.
1447@end deftypefn
1448
1449@node Type Layout
1450@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1451
1452These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1453basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1454the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1455languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1456
1457@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1458A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1459target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1460@end defmac
1461
1462@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1463A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1464target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1465(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1466unit.)
1467@end defmac
1468
1469@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1470A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1471target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1472@end defmac
1473
1474@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1475On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1476@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@.  In
1477that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1478the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1479value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1480@end defmac
1481
1482@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1483A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1484target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1485words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1486macro must be at least 64.
1487@end defmac
1488
1489@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1490A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1491target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1492@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1493@end defmac
1494
1495@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1496A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1497C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1498this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1499@end defmac
1500
1501@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1502A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1503target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1504@end defmac
1505
1506@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1507A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1508target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1509words.
1510@end defmac
1511
1512@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1514the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1515words.
1516@end defmac
1517
1518@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1520the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1521@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1526the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1527@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1528@end defmac
1529
1530@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1532the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1533@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1534@end defmac
1535
1536@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1537A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1538the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1539@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1540@end defmac
1541
1542@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1544the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1545@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1546@end defmac
1547
1548@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1550the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1551@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1556the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1557@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1558@end defmac
1559
1560@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1561A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1562the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1563@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1564@end defmac
1565
1566@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1567Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1568if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1569@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  If you don't define this, the
1570default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1571@end defmac
1572
1573@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1574Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1575@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1576@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1577anyway.  If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1578or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1579otherwise it is 0.
1580@end defmac
1581
1582@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1583Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1584@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1585anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1586is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1587@end defmac
1588
1589@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1590Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1591@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1592anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1593is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1594@end defmac
1595
1596@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1597This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1598hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true.  It
1599causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1600prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}.  A port which
1601uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1602the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1603@end defmac
1604
1605@defmac SF_SIZE
1606@defmacx DF_SIZE
1607@defmacx XF_SIZE
1608@defmacx TF_SIZE
1609Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1610@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1611if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate.  By default,
1612@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1613for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1614@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1615@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1616@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1617@end defmac
1618
1619@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1620A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1621assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1622default state.  If you do not define this macro the value of
1623@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1624@end defmac
1625
1626@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1627A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1628supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1629value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1630If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1631is the default.
1632@end defmac
1633
1634@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1635An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1636@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1637always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1638and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1639@end defmac
1640
1641@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1642This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1643@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1644of possible values of that type.  It should return false if all
1645@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1646
1647The default is to return false.
1648@end deftypefn
1649
1650@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1651A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1652for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1653contents of the string.
1654
1655The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1656spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1657appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1658of the data type names defined in the function
1659@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1660omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1661crash on startup.
1662
1663If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1664int"}.
1665@end defmac
1666
1667@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1668A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1669for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1670@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1671@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1672
1673If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1674@end defmac
1675
1676@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1677A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1678for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1679the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1680information.
1681
1682If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1683@end defmac
1684
1685@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1686A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1687characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1688@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1689@end defmac
1690
1691@defmac WINT_TYPE
1692A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1693use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1694@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1695contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1696information.
1697
1698If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1699@end defmac
1700
1701@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1702A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1703can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1704The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1705string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1706
1707If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1708@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1709much precision as @code{long long int}.
1710@end defmac
1711
1712@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1713A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1714can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1715type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1716of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1717
1718If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1719@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1720unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1721int}.
1722@end defmac
1723
1724@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1725@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1726@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1727@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1728@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1729@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1730@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1731@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1732@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1733@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1734@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1735@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1736@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1737@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1738@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1739@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1740@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1741@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1742@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1743@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1744@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1745@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1746@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1747@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1748@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1749@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1750@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1751C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1752@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1753@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1754@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1755@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1756@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1757@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1758@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1759@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}.  See
1760@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1761
1762If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1763type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1764@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1765to C99, depending on the type in question.  The defaults for all of
1766these macros are null pointers.
1767@end defmac
1768
1769@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1770The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1771that looks like:
1772
1773@smallexample
1774  struct @{
1775    union @{
1776      void (*fn)();
1777      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1778    @};
1779    ptrdiff_t delta;
1780  @};
1781@end smallexample
1782
1783@noindent
1784The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1785will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1786Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1787always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1788distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1789platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1790that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1791the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1792
1793GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1794this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1795However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1796set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1797bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1798address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1799architecture, you should define this macro to
1800@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1801
1802In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1803in which function addresses are always even, according to
1804@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1805@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1806@end defmac
1807
1808@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1809Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1810macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1811instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1812function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1813data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1814pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1815
1816If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1817of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1818@end defmac
1819
1820@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1821By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1822is the same as pointer alignment.  The value of this macro specifies
1823the alignment of the vtable entry in bits.  It should be defined only
1824when special alignment is necessary. */
1825@end defmac
1826
1827@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1828There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1829zero.  If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1830specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1831of words in each data entry.
1832@end defmac
1833
1834@node Registers
1835@section Register Usage
1836@cindex register usage
1837
1838This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1839has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1840
1841The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1842done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1843on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1844For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1845For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1846
1847@menu
1848* Register Basics::             Number and kinds of registers.
1849* Allocation Order::            Order in which registers are allocated.
1850* Values in Registers::         What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1851* Leaf Functions::              Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1852* Stack Registers::             Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1853@end menu
1854
1855@node Register Basics
1856@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1857
1858@c prevent bad page break with this line
1859Registers have various characteristics.
1860
1861@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1862Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1863numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1864pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1865@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1866@end defmac
1867
1868@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1869@cindex fixed register
1870An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1871all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1872general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1873pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1874register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1875machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1876and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1877
1878This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1879commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1880register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1881
1882The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1883the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1884by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1885the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1886@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1887@end defmac
1888
1889@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1890@cindex call-used register
1891@cindex call-clobbered register
1892@cindex call-saved register
1893Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1894clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1895registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1896available for general allocation of values that must live across
1897function calls.
1898
1899If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1900automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1901exit, if the register is used within the function.
1902@end defmac
1903
1904@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1905@cindex call-used register
1906@cindex call-clobbered register
1907@cindex call-saved register
1908Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1909that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1910(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1911This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1912of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1913@end defmac
1914
1915@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1916@cindex call-used register
1917@cindex call-clobbered register
1918@cindex call-saved register
1919A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1920value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1921call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1922macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1923preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1924@end defmac
1925
1926@findex fixed_regs
1927@findex call_used_regs
1928@findex global_regs
1929@findex reg_names
1930@findex reg_class_contents
1931@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1932This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1933@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1934@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1935any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1936of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1937@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1938@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1939called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1940@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1941from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1942@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1943@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1944@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1945command options have been applied.
1946
1947@cindex disabling certain registers
1948@cindex controlling register usage
1949If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1950flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1951@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1952registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1953the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1954to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1955is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1956
1957(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1958of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1959controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1960these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1961@end deftypefn
1962
1963@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1964Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1965expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1966corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1967function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1968outbound register.
1969@end defmac
1970
1971@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1972Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1973expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1974corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1975function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1976register.
1977@end defmac
1978
1979@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1980Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1981expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1982register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1983need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1984gotos.
1985@end defmac
1986
1987@defmac PC_REGNUM
1988If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1989register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1990@end defmac
1991
1992@node Allocation Order
1993@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1994@cindex order of register allocation
1995@cindex register allocation order
1996
1997@c prevent bad page break with this line
1998Registers are allocated in order.
1999
2000@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2001If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2002numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2003to use them (from most preferred to least).
2004
2005If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2006(all else being equal).
2007
2008One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2009registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2010instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
2011machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2012the highest numbered allocable register first.
2013@end defmac
2014
2015@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2016A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2017hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2018
2019Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2020Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2021register; and so on.
2022
2023The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2024@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2025
2026On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2027@end defmac
2028
2029@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2030Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2031prologue and restoring it in the epilogue.  This discourages it from
2032using call-saved registers.  If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2033allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2034call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2035should be defined.
2036@end defmac
2037
2038@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2039In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2040Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2041If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2042based on @var{regno}.  The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2043be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2044value returned by this macro.  Not defining this macro is equivalent
2045to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2046
2047On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2048@end defmac
2049
2050@node Values in Registers
2051@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2052
2053This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2054(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2055consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2056
2057@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2058A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2059at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2060@var{mode}.  This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2061cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2062and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2063
2064On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2065definition of this macro is
2066
2067@smallexample
2068#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
2069   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
2070    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2071@end smallexample
2072@end defmac
2073
2074@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2075A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2076in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2077in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2078multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2079this mode by the number of registers returned by
2080@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}).  By default this is zero.
2081
2082For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2083registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2084nonzero.
2085
2086This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2087@code{subreg_get_info}
2088would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2089represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2090@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2091registers and so not be representable.
2092@end defmac
2093
2094@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2095For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2096@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2097returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2098including any padding.  In the example above, the value would be four.
2099@end defmac
2100
2101@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2102Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2103of mode @var{mode} is not the word size.  It is a C expression that
2104should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode.  It is
2105used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results.  This
2106happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2107floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2108@end defmac
2109
2110@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2111A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2112of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2113registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
2114are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2115
2116@smallexample
2117#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2118@end smallexample
2119
2120You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2121because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2122
2123@cindex register pairs
2124On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2125register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2126odd register numbers for such modes.
2127
2128The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2129@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2130register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2131value into the register and back out not alter it.
2132
2133Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2134all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2135@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2136you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
2137is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2138and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2139to be tieable.
2140
2141Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2142Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2143in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
2144can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2145mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2146registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2147
2148On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2149modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
2150registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2151non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
2152@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2153floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
2154normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2155unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2156register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2157
2158The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2159they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2160instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
2161@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
2162constraints for those instructions.
2163
2164On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2165so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2166register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
2167floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2168be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2169@end defmac
2170
2171@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2172A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2173@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2174
2175One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2176another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2177handler.
2178
2179The default is always nonzero.
2180@end defmac
2181
2182@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2183A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2184@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2185
2186If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2187@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2188any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2189should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2190this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2191accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2192
2193You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2194possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2195allocation.
2196@end defmac
2197
2198@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2199This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2200@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2201
2202One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2203is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2204
2205The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2206@end deftypefn
2207
2208@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2209Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2210registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2211@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2212@end defmac
2213
2214@node Leaf Functions
2215@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2216
2217@cindex leaf functions
2218@cindex functions, leaf
2219On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2220more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
2221means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2222are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2223normally arrive.
2224
2225The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2226other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2227registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
2228function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2229handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2230functions''.
2231
2232GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2233suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
2234registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
2235accomplish this.
2236
2237@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2238Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2239contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2240function treatment.
2241
2242If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2243registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2244GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2245used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2246in this vector.
2247
2248Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2249the treatment of leaf functions.
2250@end defmac
2251
2252@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2253A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2254should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2255
2256If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2257function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2258will cause the compiler to abort.
2259
2260Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2261treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2262this.
2263@end defmac
2264
2265@findex current_function_is_leaf
2266@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2267@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2268@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2269specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2270which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2271set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2272compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2273@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2274functions which only use leaf registers.
2275@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2276that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2277@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2278@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2279@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2280
2281@node Stack Registers
2282@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2283
2284There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2285``registers'' form a stack.  Stack registers are normally written by
2286pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2287stack.
2288
2289Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2290they must be consecutively numbered.  Furthermore, the existing
2291support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2292point coprocessor.  If you have a new architecture that uses
2293stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2294@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2295with it, as well as defining these macros.
2296
2297@defmac STACK_REGS
2298Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2299@end defmac
2300
2301@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2302This is a cover class containing the stack registers.  Define this if
2303the machine has any stack-like registers.
2304@end defmac
2305
2306@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2307The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2308of the stack.
2309@end defmac
2310
2311@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2312The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2313the stack.
2314@end defmac
2315
2316@node Register Classes
2317@section Register Classes
2318@cindex register class definitions
2319@cindex class definitions, register
2320
2321On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2322For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2323certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2324restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2325
2326You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2327which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2328that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2329
2330@findex ALL_REGS
2331@findex NO_REGS
2332In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2333class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2334class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2335union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2336
2337@findex GENERAL_REGS
2338One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2339terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2340@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2341the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2342to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2343
2344Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2345then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2346
2347The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2348constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2349You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2350them in operand constraints.
2351
2352You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2353registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2354some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2355cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2356(@pxref{Costs}).
2357
2358You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2359instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2360either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2361certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2362which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2363or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2364class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2365
2366You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2367classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2368contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2369in their union.
2370
2371When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2372certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2373Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2374a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2375specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2376
2377Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2378instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2379each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2380mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2381single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2382this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2383instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2384single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2385@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2386
2387@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2388An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2389as enumerated values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2390must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2391@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2392tells how many classes there are.
2393
2394Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2395the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2396in many of the tables described below.
2397@end deftp
2398
2399@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2400The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2401
2402@smallexample
2403#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2404@end smallexample
2405@end defmac
2406
2407@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2408An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2409constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2410@end defmac
2411
2412@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2413An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2414which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2415@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2416register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2417
2418When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2419Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2420several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2421for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2422In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2423registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2424so on.
2425@end defmac
2426
2427@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2428A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2429@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2430which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2431register.
2432@end defmac
2433
2434@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2435A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2436base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2437which is the register value plus a displacement.
2438@end defmac
2439
2440@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2441This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2442the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner.  If
2443@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2444@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2445@end defmac
2446
2447@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2448A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2449base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2450register address.  You should define this macro if base plus index
2451addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2452@end defmac
2453
2454@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2455A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2456base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2457space @var{address_space} must belong.  @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2458define the context in which the base register occurs.  @var{outer_code} is
2459the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2460of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2461@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2462index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2463@end defmac
2464
2465@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2466A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2467index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2468address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2469added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2470@end defmac
2471
2472@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2473A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2475@end defmac
2476
2477@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2478A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2479that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2480@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2481reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2482you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2483@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2484addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2485@code{address_operand}.
2486@end defmac
2487
2488@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2489A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2490use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2491memory in mode @var{mode}.  It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2492pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register.  You should
2493define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2494than other base register uses.
2495
2496Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2497@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2498@end defmac
2499
2500@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2501A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2502suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2503memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2504This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2505that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2506appears in the memory reference.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2507immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2508address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2509@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the
2510corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2511@code{SCRATCH} otherwise.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2512that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2513@end defmac
2514
2515@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2516A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2517suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2518either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2519allocated such a hard register.
2520
2521The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2522the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2523two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2524labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2525labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2526may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2527looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2528only if neither labeling works.
2529@end defmac
2530
2531@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2532A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}.  By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2533@end deftypefn
2534
2535@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2536A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2537to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2538@var{rclass}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2539another, smaller class.
2540
2541The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2542
2543Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2544example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2545for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2546@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2547Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2548
2549One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2550@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2551loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2552force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2553immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2554instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2555register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2556@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2557into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2558@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2559of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2560
2561If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2562through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2563to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2564reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2565this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2566the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2567@end deftypefn
2568
2569@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2570A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2571to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2572@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2573another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2574safe:
2575
2576@smallexample
2577#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2578@end smallexample
2579
2580Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2581example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2582for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2583@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2584Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2585
2586One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2587@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2588loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2589force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2590immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2591instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2592register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2593@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2594into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2595@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2596of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2597
2598If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2599through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2600to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2601reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2602this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2603the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2604@end defmac
2605
2606@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2607Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2608input reloads.
2609
2610The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2611argument.
2612
2613You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2614reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2615@end deftypefn
2616
2617@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2618A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2619to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2620@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2621ordinarily be used.
2622
2623Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2624there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2625
2626The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2627smaller class.
2628
2629Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2630require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2631@end defmac
2632
2633@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2634Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2635from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2636@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2637from general registers, but not memory.  Below, we shall be using the
2638term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2639directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2640register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2641destination.  An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2642source and destination.  Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2643reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2644and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2645intermediate register still holds the required value.
2646
2647Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2648allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2649register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2650address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2651when compiling PIC)@.  Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2652as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2653that being copied.  Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2654describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2655these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2656of the scratch register(s).
2657
2658In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2659
2660For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2661and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2662@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}.  For output reloads, this target
2663hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2664needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2665
2666If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2667an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2668return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2669If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2670If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2671that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2672
2673If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2674perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2675closest intermediate register.  Or if no intermediate register is
2676required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2677copy  from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2678
2679You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2680in the md file which performs the move.  Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2681and input of this copy, respectively.  Operands from operand 2 onward are
2682for scratch operands.  These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2683single-register-class
2684@c [later: or memory]
2685output constraint.
2686
2687When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2688hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2689register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2690have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2691
2692@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2693@c   the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2694@c   and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2695@c   alternative.  A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2696@c   against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2697@c   constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2698@c   arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2699@c   Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2700
2701
2702@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2703pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2704Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2705in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2706
2707Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2708currently not supported.  For the time being, you will have to continue
2709to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2710
2711@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2712copied.  If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2713(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2714Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2715of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2716forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2717@end deftypefn
2718
2719@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2720@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2721@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2722These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2723@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2724
2725These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2726target hook.  Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2727reload phase that it may
2728need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2729register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2730register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2731you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2732largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2733intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2734
2735If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2736intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2737was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2738class required.  If the
2739requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2740@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2741macros identically.
2742
2743The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2744Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2745can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2746@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2747macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2748
2749If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2750intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2751@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2752(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which were normally
2753implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2754@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2755register.
2756
2757These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2758register that
2759contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2760class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2761value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2762register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2763Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2764
2765@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2766pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2767Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2768in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2769
2770These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2771registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2772registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2773would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2774the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2775intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2776general registers.
2777@end defmac
2778
2779@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2780Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2781to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2782those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2783@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2784class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2785and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2786
2787Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2788@end defmac
2789
2790@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2791Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2792allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2793If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2794defined by this macro.
2795
2796Do not define this macro if you do not define
2797@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2798@end defmac
2799
2800@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2801When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2802registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2803hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2804load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2805same as that of @var{mode}.
2806
2807This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2808bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2809in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2810registers.
2811
2812However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2813the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2814differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2815widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2816suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2817details.
2818
2819Do not define this macro if you do not define
2820@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2821is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2822@end defmac
2823
2824@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2825A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2826to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2827registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2828
2829The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2830has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise.  On most machines, this
2831default should be used.  Only use this target hook to some other expression
2832if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2833hard registers were needed for spill registers.  If this target hook returns
2834@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2835@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2836register.  If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2837you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2838the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2839allocation.
2840@end deftypefn
2841
2842@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2843A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2844of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2845
2846This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2847the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2848@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2849@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2850values in the class @var{rclass}.
2851
2852This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2853in the reload pass.
2854
2855The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2856in words.
2857@end deftypefn
2858
2859@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2860A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2861of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2862
2863This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2864the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2865should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2866@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2867
2868This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2869in the reload pass.
2870@end defmac
2871
2872@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2873If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2874a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2875
2876For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2877floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2878Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2879does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2880register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2881as below:
2882
2883@smallexample
2884#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2885  (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2886   ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2887@end smallexample
2888@end defmac
2889
2890@node Old Constraints
2891@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2892@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2893@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2894
2895Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2896of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2897Constraints}.  This mechanism is obsolete.  New ports should not use
2898it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2899
2900@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2901For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2902@var{c}, return the length.  This allows you to have register class /
2903constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2904you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2905constraints only.  The definition of this macro should use
2906DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2907to handle specially.
2908There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2909for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2910transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2911return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2912will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2913@end defmac
2914
2915@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2916A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2917letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2918value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2919the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2920corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2921to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2922@end defmac
2923
2924@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2925Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2926passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2927different variants.
2928@end defmac
2929
2930@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2931A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2932letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2933particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2934letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2935the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2936not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2937@var{value}.
2938@end defmac
2939
2940@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2941Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2942string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2943between different variants.
2944@end defmac
2945
2946@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2947A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2948letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2949(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2950
2951If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2952@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2953range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2954letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2955
2956@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2957@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2958or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2959between these kinds.
2960@end defmac
2961
2962@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2963Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2964string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2965between different variants.
2966@end defmac
2967
2968@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2969A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2970letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2971memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2972elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2973@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2974may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2975
2976If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2977if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2978constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2979constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2980
2981For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2982in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2983letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2984@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2985a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2986alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2987does not include r0 on the output.
2988@end defmac
2989
2990@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2991Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2992in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2993variants.
2994@end defmac
2995
2996@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2997A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2998letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2999be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3000
3001It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3002at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3003comprises a subset of all memory references including
3004all those whose address is simply a base register.  This allows the reload
3005pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3006type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3007
3008For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3009memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3010register.  The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3011@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3012If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3013a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3014reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3015into a base register if required.  This is analogous to the way
3016an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3017@end defmac
3018
3019@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3020A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3021letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3022@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3023be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3024
3025It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3026at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3027a subset of all memory addresses including
3028all those that consist of just a base register.  This allows the reload
3029pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3030type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3031
3032Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3033be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate.  It is treated
3034analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3035@end defmac
3036
3037@node Stack and Calling
3038@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3039@cindex calling conventions
3040
3041@c prevent bad page break with this line
3042This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3043
3044@menu
3045* Frame Layout::
3046* Exception Handling::
3047* Stack Checking::
3048* Frame Registers::
3049* Elimination::
3050* Stack Arguments::
3051* Register Arguments::
3052* Scalar Return::
3053* Aggregate Return::
3054* Caller Saves::
3055* Function Entry::
3056* Profiling::
3057* Tail Calls::
3058* Stack Smashing Protection::
3059@end menu
3060
3061@node Frame Layout
3062@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3063@cindex stack frame layout
3064@cindex frame layout
3065
3066@c prevent bad page break with this line
3067Here is the basic stack layout.
3068
3069@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3070Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3071pointer to a smaller address.
3072
3073When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3074compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3075definition used does not matter.
3076@end defmac
3077
3078@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3079This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3080on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
3081@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3082
3083The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3084and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
3085the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3086to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3087space for the next item on the stack.
3088
3089The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3090defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3091which is often wrong.
3092@end defmac
3093
3094@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3095Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3096are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3097@end defmac
3098
3099@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3100Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3101addresses on the stack.
3102@end defmac
3103
3104@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3105Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3106
3107If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3108subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3109Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3110value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3111@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3112@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
3113@end defmac
3114
3115@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3116Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3117The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3118
3119On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3120is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3121alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3122stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3123@end defmac
3124
3125@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3126Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3127outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
3128zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
3129
3130If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3131the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3132@end defmac
3133
3134@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3135Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3136address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3137function.
3138
3139If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3140the first argument's address.
3141@end defmac
3142
3143@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3144Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3145on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3146
3147The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3148length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
3149machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
3150@end defmac
3151
3152@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3153A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3154stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3155@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}.  If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3156default value will be used.  Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3157elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3158@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3159@end defmac
3160
3161@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3162A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3163frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
3164@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3165itself.
3166
3167If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3168of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3169address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3170@end defmac
3171
3172@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3173If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3174setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
3175on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3176before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
3177define this macro.
3178@end defmac
3179
3180@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3181This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3182the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3183The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3184machines.  One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3185@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3186@end deftypefn
3187
3188@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3189A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3190address for the current frame.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3191of the current frame.  This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3192You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3193as the frame pointer.  Most machines do not need to define it.
3194@end defmac
3195
3196@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3197A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3198address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3199the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3200frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3201@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3202
3203The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3204@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3205determine the return address of other frames.
3206@end defmac
3207
3208@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3209Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3210from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3211@end defmac
3212
3213@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3214A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3215incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3216prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3217value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3218the stack.
3219
3220You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3221debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3222
3223If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3224@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3225@end defmac
3226
3227@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3228A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3229number that may be used as an alternative return column.  The column
3230must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3231be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3232
3233This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3234general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3235frames.  Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3236over time.
3237@end defmac
3238
3239@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3240A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3241number that is considered to always have the value zero.  This should
3242only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3243someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3244terminate the stack backtrace.  New ports should avoid this.
3245@end defmac
3246
3247@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3248This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3249contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs.  The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3250info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3251@smallexample
3252(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3253@end smallexample
3254and
3255@smallexample
3256(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3257@end smallexample
3258to let the backend emit the call frame instructions.  @var{label} is
3259the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3260the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3261@end deftypefn
3262
3263@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3264A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3265from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3266frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
3267the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3268previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3269
3270You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3271debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3272@end defmac
3273
3274@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3275A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3276from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
3277final value should coincide with that calculated by
3278@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
3279during virtual register instantiation.
3280
3281The default value for this macro is
3282@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3283which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3284immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
3285some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3286and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3287
3288You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3289want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3290DWARF 2.
3291@end defmac
3292
3293@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3294If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3295in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3296The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3297@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3298
3299Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3300via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3301variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible.  If this macro is
3302defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3303based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer.  Only one
3304of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3305should be defined.
3306@end defmac
3307
3308@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3309If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3310in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3311in DWARF 2 debug information.  The default is zero.  A different value
3312may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3313@end defmac
3314
3315@node Exception Handling
3316@subsection Exception Handling Support
3317@cindex exception handling
3318
3319@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3320A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3321data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3322@var{N} registers are usable.
3323
3324The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3325handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
3326should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3327but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
33282 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3329
3330You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3331handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3332@end defmac
3333
3334@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3335A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3336to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3337This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3338It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3339
3340Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3341untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3342
3343Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3344by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3345this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3346stack location to be restored in place.  Otherwise, you must define
3347this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3348that provided by DWARF 2.
3349@end defmac
3350
3351@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3352A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3353to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3354return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3355
3356Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3357return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
3358address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3359the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3360frame.  If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3361been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3362target call frame.
3363
3364Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3365address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
3366the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3367
3368If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3369define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3370@end defmac
3371
3372@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3373If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3374to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3375exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3376using it to return to the exception handler.
3377@end defmac
3378
3379@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3380This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3381handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
3382that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3383and so may be read-only.
3384
3385@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3386@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3387The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3388as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3389
3390If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3391represented directly.
3392@end defmac
3393
3394@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3395This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3396to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3397Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3398be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3399
3400This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3401handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3402of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3403to be emitted.
3404@end defmac
3405
3406@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3407This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3408code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3409available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3410through signal frames.
3411
3412This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3413@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3414@file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3415@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
3416for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3417the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register
3418save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3419evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}.  If the frame cannot be decoded,
3420the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3421
3422For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3423@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3424@end defmac
3425
3426@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3427This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3428call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3429usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3430
3431This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3432@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3433@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3434for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive.  If the
3435@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3436be updated in @var{fs}.
3437@end defmac
3438
3439@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3440A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3441info to be given comdat linkage.  Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3442linkage is necessary.  The default is @code{0}.
3443@end defmac
3444
3445@node Stack Checking
3446@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3447
3448GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3449stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3450three ways:
3451
3452@enumerate
3453@item
3454If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3455will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3456at appropriate places in the configuration files.  GCC will not do
3457other special processing.
3458
3459@item
3460If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3461@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3462that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3463static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3464in the configuration files.  GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3465stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3466approach below.
3467
3468@item
3469If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3470``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3471@end enumerate
3472
3473If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3474GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3475@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3476dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3477
3478@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3479A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3480machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
3481is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3482checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach.  The default
3483value of this macro is zero.
3484@end defmac
3485
3486@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3487A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3488in a machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if you would
3489like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3490approach.  The default value of this macro is zero.
3491@end defmac
3492
3493@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3494An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3495instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer.  You will normally
3496define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3497the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The default value
3498of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3499@end defmac
3500
3501@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3502An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3503when doing probes.  This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3504contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3505thread at any point in time.  In this situation an alternate signal stack
3506is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow.  The
3507default value of this macro is zero.
3508@end defmac
3509
3510@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3511The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3512languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of 75 words
3513with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35148192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3515most machines.
3516@end defmac
3517
3518The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3519nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3520in the opposite case.
3521
3522@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3523The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
3524instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3525stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3526checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
3527default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3528systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3529@end defmac
3530
3531@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3532GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
3533represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3534space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3535You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3536use the default of four words.
3537@end defmac
3538
3539@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3540The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3541fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3542@option{-fstack-check}.
3543GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3544normally not need to override that default.
3545@end defmac
3546
3547@need 2000
3548@node Frame Registers
3549@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3550
3551@c prevent bad page break with this line
3552This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3553
3554@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3555The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3556fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
3557the hardware determines which register this is.
3558@end defmac
3559
3560@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3561The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3562access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
3563hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
3564choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3565@end defmac
3566
3567@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3568On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3569offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3570allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3571between these two locations).  On those machines, define
3572@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3573be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3574@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3575used for the frame pointer.
3576
3577You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3578is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3579the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3580completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3581definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3582@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3583or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3584
3585Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3586@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3587@end defmac
3588
3589@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3590The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3591the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
3592frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
3593register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
3594wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
3595pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3596@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3597(@pxref{Elimination}).
3598@end defmac
3599
3600@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3601Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3602@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3603the same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3604== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3605definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3606@end defmac
3607
3608@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3609Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3610@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3611same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3612ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3613definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3614@end defmac
3615
3616@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3617The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3618access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
3619machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3620pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
3621to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3622@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3623
3624Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3625address from the stack.
3626@end defmac
3627
3628@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3629@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3630Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
3631register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3632function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3633number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
3634these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3635not be defined.
3636
3637The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3638
3639If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3640defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3641@end defmac
3642
3643@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3644This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3645targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3646nested functions.  This may be required if the target has function
3647attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3648those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3649
3650The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3651
3652If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3653provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3654Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3655from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3656will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3657@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3658@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3659@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3660The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3661@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3662to refer to those items.
3663@end deftypefn
3664
3665@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3666This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3667saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3668DWARF2 exception handling.
3669
3670Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3671exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3672extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3673in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3674used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3675routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3676registers that are not call-saved.
3677
3678If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3679@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3680@end defmac
3681
3682@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3683
3684This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3685for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3686
3687If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3688@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3689@end defmac
3690
3691@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3692
3693Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3694is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3695Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3696column number to use instead.
3697
3698See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3699@end defmac
3700
3701@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3702
3703Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3704used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3705debug info sections.  Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3706should return the .eh_frame register number.  The default is
3707@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3708
3709@end defmac
3710
3711@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3712
3713Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3714that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3715should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3716.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero).  The default is to
3717return @code{@var{regno}}.
3718
3719@end defmac
3720
3721@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3722
3723Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3724@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context.  It should be defined if
3725target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}.  The
3726default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3727
3728@end defmac
3729
3730@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3731
3732Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3733context with version, args_size and by_value fields.  If it is undefined,
3734it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3735defined and 0 otherwise.
3736
3737@end defmac
3738
3739@node Elimination
3740@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3741
3742@c prevent bad page break with this line
3743This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3744
3745@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3746This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3747a frame pointer.  This target hook is called in the reload pass.  If its return
3748value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3749
3750This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3751according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3752constant @code{true} suffices.  Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3753to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3754Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3755pointer.
3756
3757In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3758without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3759automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3760@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns.  You don't need to worry about
3761them.
3762
3763In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3764register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3765fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3766
3767Default return value is @code{false}.
3768@end deftypefn
3769
3770@findex get_frame_size
3771@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3772A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3773between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3774the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3775such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3776registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3777
3778If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3779need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3780@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3781case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3782@end defmac
3783
3784@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3785If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3786eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3787defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3788references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3789
3790The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3791of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3792
3793On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3794the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3795must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3796replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3797depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3798
3799In this case, you might specify:
3800@smallexample
3801#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3802@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3803 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3804 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3805@end smallexample
3806
3807Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3808specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3809@end defmac
3810
3811@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3812This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3813try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3814@var{to_reg}.  This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3815is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3816preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3817knows about.
3818
3819Default return value is @code{true}.
3820@end deftypefn
3821
3822@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3823This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3824specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3825registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3826defined.
3827@end defmac
3828
3829@node Stack Arguments
3830@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3831@cindex arguments on stack
3832@cindex stack arguments
3833
3834The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3835on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3836control passing certain arguments in registers.
3837
3838@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3839This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3840prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3841passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3842cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3843The default is to not promote prototypes.
3844@end deftypefn
3845
3846@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3847A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3848outgoing arguments.
3849If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3850That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3851allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3852it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3853@end defmac
3854
3855@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3856A C expression.  If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3857last to first, rather than from first to last.  If this macro is not
3858defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3859and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3860@end defmac
3861
3862@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3863A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3864stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3865
3866On some machines, the definition
3867
3868@smallexample
3869#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3870@end smallexample
3871
3872@noindent
3873will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3874to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3875alignment.  Then the definition should be
3876
3877@smallexample
3878#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3879@end smallexample
3880
3881If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3882@end defmac
3883
3884@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3885@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3886A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3887will be computed and placed into the variable
3888@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3889onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3890increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3891
3892Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3893is not proper.
3894@end defmac
3895
3896@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3897Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3898allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3899registers.
3900
3901The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3902arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3903which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3904The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3905of the function.
3906
3907This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3908machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3909which.
3910@end defmac
3911@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3912@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3913
3914@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3915Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3916caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3917when calling a function of @var{fntype}.  @var{fntype} may be NULL
3918if the function called is a library function.
3919
3920If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3921whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3922@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3923@end defmac
3924
3925@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3926Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3927stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3928@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3929@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3930
3931Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3932stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3933suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3934stack in its natural location.
3935@end defmac
3936
3937@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3938This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3939a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3940and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3941
3942@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3943the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3944@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3945From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3946
3947@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3948describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3949@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3950From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3951arguments (if known).
3952
3953When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3954will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3955you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3956by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3957a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3958in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3959
3960@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3961stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3962argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3963
3964On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3965of this macro is @var{size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3966calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3967the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3968convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3969arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3970nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3971@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3972number of arguments.
3973@end deftypefn
3974
3975@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3976A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3977pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3978when compiling a function call.
3979
3980@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3981have been accumulated.
3982
3983On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3984that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3985that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3986call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3987appropriate.
3988@end defmac
3989
3990@node Register Arguments
3991@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3992@cindex arguments in registers
3993@cindex registers arguments
3994
3995This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3996types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3997the stack.
3998
3999@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4000Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4001register and if so, which register.
4002
4003The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4004arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4005the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4006(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4007which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4008nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4009function's prototype.  @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4010syntax error has previously occurred.
4011
4012The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4013register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4014on the stack.
4015
4016The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
4017used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
4018@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
4019@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4020describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
4021@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4022register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4023register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
4024second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4025the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4026As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4027RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
4028argument is also stored on the stack.
4029
4030The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4031VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4032pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4033
4034@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4035The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4036machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4037cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is
4038done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4039@var{named} is @code{false}.
4040
4041@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4042@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4043You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4044in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4045type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4046is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4047argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4048defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4049a register.
4050@end deftypefn
4051
4052@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4053This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4054solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4055definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4056documentation.
4057@end deftypefn
4058
4059@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4060Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4061that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4062necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4063argument.
4064
4065For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4066which the caller passes the value, and
4067@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4068fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4069arrive.
4070
4071If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4072@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4073@end deftypefn
4074
4075@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4076This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4077argument that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
4078arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4079pushed on the stack.
4080
4081On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4082registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
4083first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4084on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4085structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4086in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
4087compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4088
4089@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4090register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4091@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4092@end deftypefn
4093
4094@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4095This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4096position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference.  This
4097predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4098passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4099
4100If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4101pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4102The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4103to that type.
4104@end deftypefn
4105
4106@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4107The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4108known to be passed by reference.  The hook should return true if the
4109function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4110by the caller.
4111
4112For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4113determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4114not be generated.
4115
4116The default version of this hook always returns false.
4117@end deftypefn
4118
4119@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4120A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4121of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some
4122target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4123of bytes of argument so far.
4124
4125There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4126arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
4127variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
4128arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4129@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4130should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4131@end defmac
4132
4133@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4134If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4135function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4136created.  The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4137reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4138If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4139@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4140@end defmac
4141
4142@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4143A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4144@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The
4145variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype}
4146is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4147the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4148For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4149declaration node of the function.  @var{fndecl} is also set when
4150@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4151being compiled.  @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4152arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4153parameter, when making a call.  When processing incoming arguments,
4154@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4155
4156When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4157@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4158contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
4159an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
4160macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4161never both of them at once.
4162@end defmac
4163
4164@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4165Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4166it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4167@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
4168is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41690)} is used instead.
4170@end defmac
4171
4172@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4173Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4174finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
4175undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4176
4177The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4178with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
4179argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4180@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4181@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4182@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
4183@end defmac
4184
4185@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4186This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4187advance past an argument in the argument list.  The values @var{mode},
4188@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.  Once this is done,
4189the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4190argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4191
4192This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4193on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4194used for arguments without any special help.
4195@end deftypefn
4196
4197@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4198If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4199offset of the argument passed in memory.  This is needed for the SPU,
4200which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4201slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4202top.
4203@end defmac
4204
4205@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4206If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4207to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
4208@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4209@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4210
4211The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4212target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}.  It is
4213always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4214
4215This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4216For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
4217big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4218constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4219@end defmac
4220
4221@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4222If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4223implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4224next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4225controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
4226arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4227@end defmac
4228
4229@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4230Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4231memory.  @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element.  Defining this
4232macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4233machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl.  In particular,
4234@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4235registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register;  For example,
4236a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4237required.
4238@end defmac
4239
4240@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4241This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4242with the specified mode and type.  The default hook returns
4243@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4244@end deftypefn
4245
4246@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4247Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4248which is the default value for this hook.  You can define this hook to
4249return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4250value.
4251@end deftypefn
4252
4253@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4254A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4255register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
4256@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4257the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
4258used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4259stack.
4260@end defmac
4261
4262@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4263This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4264as two scalar parameters.  By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4265arguments into the target's word size.  Some ABIs require complex arguments
4266to be split and treated as their individual components.  For example, on
4267AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4268registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4269point register.
4270
4271The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4272false.
4273@end deftypefn
4274
4275@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4276This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4277The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4278@end deftypefn
4279
4280@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4281This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4282to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4283variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4284to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4285variable.
4286The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4287this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4288internal type.
4289If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4290Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4291macro to iterate through all types.
4292@end deftypefn
4293
4294@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4295This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4296@var{fndecl}.
4297The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4298@end deftypefn
4299
4300@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4301This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4302type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4303@code{NULL_TREE}.
4304@end deftypefn
4305
4306@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4307This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4308@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}.  The first two parameters correspond to the
4309arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4310@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4311@end deftypefn
4312
4313@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4314Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4315with machine mode @var{mode}.  The default version of this
4316hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4317@end deftypefn
4318
4319@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4320Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref}  may alias with the system C library errno location.  The default  version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location  is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing  a pointer to int.
4321@end deftypefn
4322
4323@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4324Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4325insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}.  For a scalar mode to be
4326considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4327must work.
4328
4329The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4330required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4331Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4332code in @file{optabs.c}.
4333@end deftypefn
4334
4335@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4336Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4337insns involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it
4338must have move patterns for this mode.
4339@end deftypefn
4340
4341@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4342Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4343of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4344Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4345and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4346
4347One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4348that operate on several homogeneous vectors.  For example, ARM NEON
4349has operations like:
4350
4351@smallexample
4352int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4353@end smallexample
4354
4355where the return type is defined as:
4356
4357@smallexample
4358typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4359@{
4360  int8x8_t val[3];
4361@} int8x8x3_t;
4362@end smallexample
4363
4364If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4365@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode.  GCC can then store
4366@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4367@end deftypefn
4368
4369@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4370Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4371small register classes.  If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4372@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4373in @var{mode}.  The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4374In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4375for any mode.
4376
4377On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4378insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4379to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4380if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4381insn.
4382
4383Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4384in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4385the instruction are already known.  And for some machines, register
4386classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4387registers.  For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4388registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4389SSE registers for floating point operations.  On such targets, a good
4390strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4391machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4392
4393The default version of this hook returns false for any mode.  It is always
4394safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value.  But if you
4395unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4396that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this hook
4397to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4398of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4399@end deftypefn
4400
4401@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4402If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4403@end deftypevr
4404
4405@node Scalar Return
4406@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4407@cindex return values in registers
4408@cindex values, returned by functions
4409@cindex scalars, returned as values
4410
4411This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4412values---values that can fit in registers.
4413
4414@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4415
4416Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4417returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4418representing a data type.  @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4419representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4420function being called.  If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4421compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4422Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4423a function returns a value.
4424
4425On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4426(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4427place regardless of mode.)  The value of the expression is usually a
4428@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4429The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4430multiple places.  See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4431@code{parallel} form.   Note that the callee will populate every
4432location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4433the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4434that element as the canonical location and ignore the others.  The m68k
4435port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4436@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4437
4438If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4439the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4440@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4441
4442If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4443node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4444pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4445convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4446known.
4447
4448Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4449which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4450the caller sees the value.  For such machines, you should return
4451different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4452
4453@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4454aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
4455@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4456@end deftypefn
4457
4458@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4459This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4460a new target instead.
4461@end defmac
4462
4463@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4464A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4465function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4466
4467Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4468support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4469specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4470compiled.
4471@end defmac
4472
4473@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4474Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4475function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4476
4477The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4478library function is given by @var{fun}.  The hook should return an RTX
4479representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4480
4481If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4482@end deftypefn
4483
4484@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4485A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4486register in which the values of called function may come back.
4487
4488A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4489second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4490recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
4491suffices:
4492
4493@smallexample
4494#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4495@end smallexample
4496
4497If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4498function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4499should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4500
4501This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4502for a new target instead.
4503@end defmac
4504
4505@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4506A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4507register in which the values of called function may come back.
4508
4509A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4510second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4511recognized by this target hook.
4512
4513If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4514function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4515should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4516
4517If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4518@end deftypefn
4519
4520@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4521Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4522need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4523saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4524@end defmac
4525
4526@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4527This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4528at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4529padded at the least significant end).  You can assume that @var{type}
4530is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4531
4532Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4533be able to hold the complete return value.  For example, if a 1-, 2-
4534or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45354-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4536@code{SImode} rtx.
4537@end deftypefn
4538
4539@node Aggregate Return
4540@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4541@cindex aggregates as return values
4542@cindex large return values
4543@cindex returning aggregate values
4544@cindex structure value address
4545
4546When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4547cases), the value is not returned according to
4548@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the
4549caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4550should be stored.  This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4551address}.
4552
4553This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4554memory.
4555
4556@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4557This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4558function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4559Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4560will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4561libcalls.
4562
4563Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4564by this function.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4565takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
4566possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4567definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4568values, and 0 otherwise.
4569
4570Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4571be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4572to indicate this.
4573@end deftypefn
4574
4575@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4576Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4577in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4578only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4579If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4580and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4581target hook.
4582
4583If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4584@end defmac
4585
4586@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4587This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4588address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4589passed as an ``invisible'' first argument.  Note that @var{fndecl} may
4590be @code{NULL}, for libcalls.  You do not need to define this target
4591hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4592argument.
4593
4594On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4595is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4596caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
4597be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4598@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4599the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4600the caller.
4601
4602If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4603stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4604@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4605structure value address at the beginning of a function.  If you need
4606to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4607@end deftypefn
4608
4609@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4610Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4611for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4612the address of a static variable containing the value.
4613
4614Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4615pass an address to the subroutine.
4616
4617This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4618nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4619@end defmac
4620
4621@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4622This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}.  Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4623@end deftypefn
4624
4625@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4626This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}.  Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4627@end deftypefn
4628
4629@node Caller Saves
4630@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4631
4632If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
4633makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4634must live across calls.
4635
4636@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4637A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4638a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4639restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
4640this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4641
4642If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4643machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4644@end defmac
4645
4646@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4647A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4648of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
4649@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4650returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4651will select the smallest suitable mode.
4652@end defmac
4653
4654@node Function Entry
4655@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4656@cindex function entry and exit
4657@cindex prologue
4658@cindex epilogue
4659
4660This section describes the macros that output function entry
4661(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4662
4663@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4664If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4665function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4666initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4667saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4668local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
4669stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4670
4671The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4672macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
4673
4674@findex regs_ever_live
4675To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4676@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4677@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
4678prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4679call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4680@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4681
4682On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4683not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4684they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4685appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4686registers are used in the function.
4687
4688@findex frame_pointer_needed
4689On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4690function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4691pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
4692frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4693@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
4694time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
4695
4696The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4697required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
4698listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4699order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4700stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4701the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
4702for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4703compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
4704or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4705need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4706@end deftypefn
4707
4708@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4709If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4710prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
4711emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4712emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4713@end deftypefn
4714
4715@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4716If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4717epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4718emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4719emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4720@end deftypefn
4721
4722@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4723If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4724function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4725registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4726called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
4727same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4728registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4729@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4730
4731On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4732of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
4733instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4734@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4735
4736Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4737@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
4738switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4739define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4740target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4741condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4742
4743On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4744function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
4745two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
4746is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4747@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4748a function that needs a frame pointer.
4749
4750Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4751@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4752The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4753function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4754
4755On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4756others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
4757given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4758number of arguments.
4759
4760@findex current_function_pops_args
4761Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4762functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4763needs to know what was decided.  The number of bytes of the current
4764function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4765@code{crtl->args.pops_args}.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
4766@end deftypefn
4767
4768@itemize @bullet
4769@item
4770@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4771A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4772uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4773stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4774if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4775arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4776yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
4777region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4778registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4779features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4780
4781@item
4782An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4783The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4784the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4785machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4786in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
4787a save area.
4788
4789@item
4790A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4791boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
4792this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4793save area closer to the top of the stack.
4794
4795@item
4796@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4797Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4798@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4799argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4800@end itemize
4801
4802@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4803Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4804instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4805pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4806adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.  The
4807default is 0.
4808
4809Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4810frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
4811stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4812compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4813@end defmac
4814
4815@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4816Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4817used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
4818pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4819@end defmac
4820
4821@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4822Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4823used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4824on entry to an exception edge.
4825@end defmac
4826
4827@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4828Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4829instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
4830definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4831representing the number of delay slots there.
4832@end defmac
4833
4834@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4835A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4836slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4837
4838The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4839being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4840eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
4841of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4842If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4843may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
4844(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4845slot.
4846
4847@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4848@findex final_scan_insn
4849The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4850list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4851@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
4852delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
4853@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4854outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4855@code{final_scan_insn}.
4856
4857You need not define this macro if you did not define
4858@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4859@end defmac
4860
4861@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4862A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4863function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4864inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4865adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4866the real function.
4867
4868First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4869contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4870contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4871in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4872e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4873all other incoming arguments.
4874
4875Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4876made after adding @code{delta}.  In particular, if @var{p} is the
4877adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4878
4879@smallexample
4880p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4881@end smallexample
4882
4883After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4884@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4885not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4886return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4887
4888The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4889the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4890of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4891and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4892
4893The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4894have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4895some targets, but probably not.
4896
4897If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4898front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4899@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4900not support varargs.
4901@end deftypefn
4902
4903@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4904A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4905to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4906arguments it is passed, and false otherwise.  In the latter case, the
4907generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4908previously exposed.
4909@end deftypefn
4910
4911@node Profiling
4912@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4913@cindex profiling, code generation
4914
4915These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4916
4917@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4918A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4919assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4920
4921@findex mcount
4922The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4923your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4924compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4925compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4926
4927Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4928variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4929@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4930the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4931@end defmac
4932
4933@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4934A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4935code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4936not support profiling.
4937@end defmac
4938
4939@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4940Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4941@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4942allocated for each function.  This is true for almost all modern
4943implementations.  If you define this macro, you must not use the
4944@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4945@end defmac
4946
4947@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4948Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4949the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4950@end defmac
4951
4952@node Tail Calls
4953@subsection Permitting tail calls
4954@cindex tail calls
4955
4956@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4957True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4958call expression @var{exp}.  @var{decl} will be the called function,
4959or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4960
4961It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4962tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4963during PIC compilation.  The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4964as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4965``normal'' call.  The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4966may vary greatly between different architectures.
4967@end deftypefn
4968
4969@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4970Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4971function.  This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4972cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4973registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4974TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4975FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4976@end deftypefn
4977
4978@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4979This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4980@end deftypefn
4981
4982@node Stack Smashing Protection
4983@subsection Stack smashing protection
4984@cindex stack smashing protection
4985
4986@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4987This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4988for the stack protection guard.  This variable is initialized by the
4989runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4990that is placed at the top of the local stack frame.  The type of this
4991variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4992
4993The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4994@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4995@end deftypefn
4996
4997@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4998This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4999stack protect guard variable has been modified.  This expression should
5000involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5001
5002The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5003@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments.  This function is
5004normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5005@end deftypefn
5006
5007@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5008Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed.  This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations.  The default version of this hook returns false.  If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5009@end deftypefn
5010
5011@node Varargs
5012@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5013@cindex varargs implementation
5014
5015GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5016@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5017on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
5018varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5019conditionals to include it.
5020
5021ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5022the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
5023implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5024to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
5025@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
5026supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5027
5028However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
5029the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5030below.
5031
5032@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5033Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5034that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
5035versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5036you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5037
5038On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5039control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On
5040other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5041found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5042
5043Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5044beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5045@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5046This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5047to use them for its own purposes.
5048@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5049@c 10feb93
5050@end defmac
5051
5052@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5053This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5054argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5055returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5056argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5057fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5058verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5059of the current function.
5060@end defmac
5061
5062@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5063Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5064passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5065has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
5066specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5067with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5068
5069@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5070considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
5071kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5072
5073The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5074interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5075@end defmac
5076
5077These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5078
5079@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5080If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5081@code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the very
5082beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.  The
5083return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5084to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5085@end deftypefn
5086
5087@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5088This target hook offers an alternative to using
5089@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5090@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the anonymous
5091register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5092have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is done, you can
5093use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5094pass all their arguments on the stack.
5095
5096The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5097structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5098named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5099last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5100
5101The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5102argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5103store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5104variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you
5105store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5106frame.
5107
5108Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5109compile time without knowing their data types,
5110@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5111have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5112for all data types.
5113
5114If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5115arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
5116happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5117end of the source file.  The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5118not generate any instructions in this case.
5119@end deftypefn
5120
5121@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5122Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5123argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5124
5125This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5126is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this hook returns
5127@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5128arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns @code{false},
5129but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5130then all arguments are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments
5131except the last are treated as named.
5132
5133You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5134@end deftypefn
5135
5136@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5137If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5138@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5139@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5140defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5141@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5142Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5143@end deftypefn
5144
5145@node Trampolines
5146@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5147@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5148@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5149
5150A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5151when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
5152the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
5153tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5154trampoline.
5155
5156The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5157address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5158the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5159two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
5160exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
5161machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5162two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5163operands.
5164
5165The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5166parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5167immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
5168simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5169proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
5170may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5171separately.
5172
5173@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5174This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5175on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5176the constant parts of a trampoline.  This code should not include a
5177label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5178
5179If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5180for the target.  Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5181code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5182to generate it on the spot.
5183@end deftypefn
5184
5185@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5186Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5187(@pxref{Sections}).  The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5188@end defmac
5189
5190@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5191A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5192@end defmac
5193
5194@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5195Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5196
5197If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5198is used for aligning trampolines.
5199@end defmac
5200
5201@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5202This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5203@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5204is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5205RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5206when it is called.
5207
5208If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5209first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5210from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5211Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5212trampoline.  If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5213to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5214
5215If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5216enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5217initializing the trampoline proper.
5218@end deftypefn
5219
5220@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5221This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5222the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address of the
5223memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}.  In case
5224the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5225address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5226be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5227If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5228@end deftypefn
5229
5230Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5231separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
5232fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5233jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5234
5235Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
5236the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
5237make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5238subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5239latter makes initialization faster.
5240
5241To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5242the following macro.
5243
5244@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5245If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5246cache} in the specified interval.  The definition of this macro would
5247typically be a series of @code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and
5248@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5249@end defmac
5250
5251To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
5252you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5253cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5254beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5255its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5256
5257@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5258Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5259work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5260which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
5261@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5262
5263If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5264C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5265special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
5266statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5267global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5268special assembler code.
5269@end defmac
5270
5271@node Library Calls
5272@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5273@cindex library subroutine names
5274@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5275
5276@c prevent bad page break with this line
5277Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5278
5279@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5280This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5281expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a.  It can be used to
5282provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5283are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5284@end defmac
5285
5286@findex set_optab_libfunc
5287@findex init_one_libfunc
5288@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5289This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5290existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5291@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5292@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5293library routines.
5294
5295The default is to do nothing.  Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5296@end deftypefn
5297
5298@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5299If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5300underscores.  If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5301instead.  E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}.  This
5302currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.  If this
5303is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5304@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5305@end deftypevr
5306
5307@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5308This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5309implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5310mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5311return a tristate.
5312
5313GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5314comparison operators, so the default returns false always.  Most ports
5315don't need to define this macro.
5316@end defmac
5317
5318@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5319This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5320functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5321operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5322and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5323If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5324@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2.  If the target uses the routines
5325in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5326@end defmac
5327
5328@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5329@findex matherr
5330@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5331The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5332expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5333deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
5334@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5335system.
5336
5337If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5338domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5339error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5340there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5341that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5342@end defmac
5343
5344@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5345@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5346Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5347refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
5348@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
5349macro, a reasonable default is used.
5350@end defmac
5351
5352@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5353@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5354When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5355@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard.  The
5356default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5357functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5358systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5359@end defmac
5360
5361@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5362@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5363When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5364and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}.  The
5365default is zero.  The target has to provide the following functions:
5366@smallexample
5367void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5368void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5369void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5370@end smallexample
5371@end defmac
5372
5373@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5374Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5375by default.  This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5376and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5377This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5378the NeXT runtime installed.
5379
5380If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5381will be used by default.  This convention passes just the object and the
5382selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5383
5384In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5385scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5386@end defmac
5387
5388@node Addressing Modes
5389@section Addressing Modes
5390@cindex addressing modes
5391
5392@c prevent bad page break with this line
5393This is about addressing modes.
5394
5395@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5396@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5397@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5398@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5399A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5400pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5401@end defmac
5402
5403@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5404@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5405A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5406post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5407the size of the memory operand.
5408@end defmac
5409
5410@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5411@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5412A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5413post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5414@end defmac
5415
5416@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5417A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5418is a valid address.  On most machines the default definition of
5419@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5420is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5421constant addresses are supported.
5422@end defmac
5423
5424@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5425@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5426accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5427known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5428expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5429@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5430@end defmac
5431
5432@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5433A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5434memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5435the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5436accept.
5437@end defmac
5438
5439@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5440A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5441address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5442
5443Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5444non-strict one.  The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5445desired by the caller.
5446
5447The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It must be defined so
5448that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5449considered a memory reference.  This is because in contexts where some
5450kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5451must be rejected.  For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5452up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5453register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5454if the array holds @code{-1}.
5455
5456The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
5457accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5458register is required.
5459
5460Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5461and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5462constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5463specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
5464recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5465
5466Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5467sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
5468@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5469naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5470be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5471
5472@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5473On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5474the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
5475target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5476into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
5477@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5478@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
5479Format}.
5480
5481@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5482Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5483this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro.  This macro
5484has this syntax:
5485
5486@example
5487#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5488@end example
5489
5490@noindent
5491and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5492address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5493
5494@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5495Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5496macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
5497@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5498that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5499
5500Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5501files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5502@end deftypefn
5503
5504@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5505A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5506character for general memory addresses.  This defines the constraint
5507letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5508@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}.  Define this macro if you want to
5509support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5510semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint.  This is necessary in order to
5511preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5512@code{'m'} constraint.
5513@end defmac
5514
5515@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5516A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5517or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5518can easily find the base term.  This macro is used in only two places:
5519@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5520
5521It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
5522that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5523
5524The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5525a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5526@end defmac
5527
5528@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5529This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5530operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5531address.
5532
5533@findex break_out_memory_refs
5534@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5535and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5536@var{x}.
5537
5538The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5539@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5540should return the new @var{x}.
5541
5542It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5543The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In fact, it
5544is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5545a valid way to legitimize the address.  But often a machine-dependent
5546strategy can generate better code.
5547@end deftypefn
5548
5549@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5550A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5551that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5552@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5553It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5554performance reasons.
5555
5556For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5557reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5558registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
5559processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5560needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
5561@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5562generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5563be shared.
5564
5565@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
5566to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5567and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5568of reload internals.
5569
5570@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5571previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
5572then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5573
5574@findex push_reload
5575The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5576need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5577suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5578
5579The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5580@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5581should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5582This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5583@code{push_reload}.
5584
5585@findex strict_memory_address_p
5586The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5587the address has become legitimate.
5588
5589@findex copy_rtx
5590If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5591this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that it unshares only a
5592single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5593top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5594It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5595address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5596@end defmac
5597
5598@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5599This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5600different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5601reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5602but not others.
5603
5604Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5605effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5606of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5607addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5608
5609You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5610
5611The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5612@end deftypefn
5613
5614@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5615A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5616@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5617different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5618reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5619but not others.
5620
5621Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5622effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5623of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5624addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5625
5626You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5627
5628These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5629@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5630@end defmac
5631
5632@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5633This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5634@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
5635@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5636
5637The default definition returns true.
5638@end deftypefn
5639
5640@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5641This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5642@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5643macros.  Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5644references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5645addressing modes.  This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5646the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5647into their original form.
5648@end deftypefn
5649
5650@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5651This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5652debug sections.
5653@end deftypefn
5654
5655@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5656This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5657should not) be spilled to the constant pool.  @var{mode} is the mode
5658of @var{x}.
5659
5660The default version of this hook returns false.
5661
5662The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5663deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5664from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5665holding the constant.  This restriction is often true of addresses
5666of TLS symbols for various targets.
5667@end deftypefn
5668
5669@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5670This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5671be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.  @var{mode} is the mode
5672of @var{x}.
5673
5674The default version returns false for all constants.
5675@end deftypefn
5676
5677@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5678This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5679the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5680@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.  @var{md_fn} is true
5681when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function.  When
5682@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5683of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5684function are valid.
5685@end deftypefn
5686
5687@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5688This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5689address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5690used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5691@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5692
5693The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5694@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5695the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5696@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5697two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5698@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5699the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5700from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5701@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5702@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5703@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5704
5705If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5706to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5707use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5708@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5709should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5710described above.
5711If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5712the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5713log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5714@end deftypefn
5715
5716@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN (tree @var{x})
5717This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5718widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5719
5720If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5721@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5722widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5723preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5724@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5725@end deftypefn
5726
5727@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD (tree @var{x})
5728This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5729widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5730
5731If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5732@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5733widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5734preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5735@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5736@end deftypefn
5737
5738@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5739Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5740For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5741misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5742@end deftypefn
5743
5744@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5745Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5746@end deftypefn
5747
5748@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5749Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5750@end deftypefn
5751
5752@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5753This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5754input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5755The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5756specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5757(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5758
5759If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5760@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5761conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5762@end deftypefn
5763
5764@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5765This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5766vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5767@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5768The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration.  The
5769return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5770@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5771@end deftypefn
5772
5773@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5774This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5775store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5776parameter.  The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5777the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}.  @var{is_packed}
5778parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5779@end deftypefn
5780
5781@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5782This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5783mode @var{mode}.  The default is
5784equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5785transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5786@end deftypefn
5787
5788@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5789This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5790after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5791mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5792The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5793@end deftypefn
5794
5795@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5796This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5797@end deftypefn
5798
5799@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5800This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5801@end deftypefn
5802
5803@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5804Target builtin that implements vector gather operation.  @var{mem_vectype}
5805is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5806the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5807The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5808loads.
5809@end deftypefn
5810
5811@node Anchored Addresses
5812@section Anchored Addresses
5813@cindex anchored addresses
5814@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5815
5816GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5817For example, if we have:
5818
5819@smallexample
5820static int a, b, c;
5821int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5822@end smallexample
5823
5824the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5825addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}.  On some targets,
5826it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5827the three variables relative to it.  The equivalent pseudocode would
5828be something like:
5829
5830@smallexample
5831int foo (void)
5832@{
5833  register int *xr = &x;
5834  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5835@}
5836@end smallexample
5837
5838(which isn't valid C).  We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5839``section anchors''.  Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5840
5841The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5842in order to make effective use of section anchors.  It won't use
5843section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5844or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5845
5846@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5847The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5848On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5849applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5850for every mode.  The default value is 0.
5851@end deftypevr
5852
5853@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5854Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5855offset that should be applied to section anchors.  The default
5856value is 0.
5857@end deftypevr
5858
5859@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5860Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5861@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5862The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5863of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5864
5865If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5866it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5867If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5868is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5869@end deftypefn
5870
5871@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5872Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5873@var{x}.  You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5874@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5875
5876The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5877intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5878or target-specific sections.
5879@end deftypefn
5880
5881@node Condition Code
5882@section Condition Code Status
5883@cindex condition code status
5884
5885The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5886two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5887
5888The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5889(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5890clobber of the condition codes.  The second is the condition code
5891register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5892architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5893most instructions do not affect it.  The latter category includes
5894most RISC machines.
5895
5896The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5897the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5898insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}.  This can prevent important
5899optimizations on some machines.  For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5900is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5901three instructions earlier than the conditional branch.  The instruction
5902scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5903separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5904
5905For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5906represent the condition code for new ports.  If there is a specific
5907condition code register in the machine, use a hard register.  If the
5908condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5909or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5910Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5911that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5912
5913Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5914specified already in the compare instruction.  In this case, you are not
5915interested in most macros in this section.
5916
5917@menu
5918* CC0 Condition Codes::      Old style representation of condition codes.
5919* MODE_CC Condition Codes::  Modern representation of condition codes.
5920* Cond Exec Macros::         Macros to control conditional execution.
5921@end menu
5922
5923@node CC0 Condition Codes
5924@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5925@findex cc0
5926
5927@findex cc_status
5928The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5929describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5930the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
5931variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5932currently based, and several standard flags.
5933
5934Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5935description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
5936information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5937
5938@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5939C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5940component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
5941
5942This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5943@end defmac
5944
5945@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5946A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5947The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5948the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
5949define this macro to initialize it.
5950
5951This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5952@end defmac
5953
5954@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5955A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5956appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
5957this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5958code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5959set @code{(cc0)}.
5960
5961This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5962
5963If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5964other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5965invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5966reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5967registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5968@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5969insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5970based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5971value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
5972this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5973@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5974@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5975condition code value.
5976
5977The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5978with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5979@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5980constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
5981insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
5982@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5983@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5984
5985A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5986that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5987@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5988two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5989@end defmac
5990
5991@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5992@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5993@findex CCmode
5994@findex MODE_CC
5995
5996@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5997On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5998than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5999code set by a subtract instruction.  However, on some machines
6000when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6001bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6002branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches.  When
6003this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6004record different formats of the condition code register.  Modes can
6005also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6006unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6007
6008If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6009@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6010a mode given an operand of a compare.  This is needed because the modes
6011have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6012by instruction combination.  The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6013be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6014the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6015
6016@smallexample
6017(define_insn ""
6018  [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6019        (compare:CC_NOOV
6020          (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6021                   (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6022          (const_int 0)))]
6023  ""
6024  "@dots{}")
6025@end smallexample
6026
6027@noindent
6028together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6029for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6030
6031@smallexample
6032#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6033  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
6034   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
6035   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
6036       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6037      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6038@end smallexample
6039
6040Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6041were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6042this section.
6043
6044You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6045in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6046@end defmac
6047
6048@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6049On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6050convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
6051does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6052comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6053
6054On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6055required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6056and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6057comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6058@var{op1} as required.
6059
6060GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6061valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6062@file{md} file.
6063
6064You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6065code or operands.
6066@end defmac
6067
6068@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6069A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6070comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6071can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6072then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6073
6074You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6075floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6076For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6077inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6078
6079@smallexample
6080#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6081@end smallexample
6082@end defmac
6083
6084@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6085A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6086comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
6087@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
6088machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
6089instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6090freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
6091like:
6092
6093@smallexample
6094#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6095   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6096    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6097@end smallexample
6098@end defmac
6099
6100@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6101On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6102register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6103regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6104hard register is set to a common value.  Use this hook to enable a
6105small pass which optimizes such cases.  This hook should return true
6106to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6107arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6108When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6109integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6110@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6111
6112The default version of this hook returns false.
6113@end deftypefn
6114
6115@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6116On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6117@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6118validly done in more than one mode.  On such a system, define this
6119target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6120both comparisons may be validly done.  If there is no such mode,
6121return @code{VOIDmode}.
6122
6123The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6124same.  If they are, it returns that mode.  If they are different, it
6125returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6126@end deftypefn
6127
6128@node Cond Exec Macros
6129@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6130@findex conditional execution
6131@findex predication
6132
6133There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6134supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6135represent conditional branches.
6136
6137@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6138A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6139@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6140versa.  Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6141predicates that cannot be reversed safely.  There is no need to validate
6142that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6143If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6144
6145@smallexample
6146#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6147   (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6148@end smallexample
6149@end defmac
6150
6151@node Costs
6152@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6153@cindex costs of instructions
6154@cindex relative costs
6155@cindex speed of instructions
6156
6157These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6158on the target machine.
6159
6160@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6161A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6162register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
6163expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
6164value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6165that.
6166
6167It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6168same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6169registers if they are not general registers.
6170
6171If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6172hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6173classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6174constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6175allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6176if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6177
6178These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6179@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6180@end defmac
6181
6182@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6183This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6184from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes
6185are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6186A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6187that.
6188
6189It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6190same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6191registers if they are not general registers.
6192
6193If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6194hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6195classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6196constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6197allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6198if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6199
6200The default version of this function returns 2.
6201@end deftypefn
6202
6203@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6204A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6205register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6206is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
6207is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
6208registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6209should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6210
6211If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6212the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6213needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6214between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6215more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6216reflect the actual cost of the move.
6217
6218GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6219secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6220a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6221secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62224 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6223value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6224are the same as to this macro.
6225
6226These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6227@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6228@end defmac
6229
6230@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6231This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6232between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6233if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6234This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6235If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6236registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6237
6238If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6239the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6240needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6241between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6242more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6243reflect the actual cost of the move.
6244
6245GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6246secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6247a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6248secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62494 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6250value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6251are the same as to this target hook.
6252@end deftypefn
6253
6254@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6255A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
6256the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6257@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6258for speed.  When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6259optimal for code size rather than performance.  @var{predictable_p} is
6260true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6261@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6262@end defmac
6263
6264Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6265but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6266ordinarily expect.
6267
6268@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6269Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6270than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6271faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6272require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6273between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6274
6275When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6276finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6277load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
6278faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6279may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6280other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6281@end defmac
6282
6283@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6284Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6285@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6286than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6287handler.
6288
6289When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6290@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6291moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6292Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6293cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6294
6295If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
6296this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6297@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6298@end defmac
6299
6300@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6301The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6302which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6303string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
6304make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6305
6306Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6307@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6308the number of such sequences.
6309
6310The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6311optimized for speed rather than size.
6312
6313If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6314@end defmac
6315
6316@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6317A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6318copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6319will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6320than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6321@end defmac
6322
6323@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6324A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6325a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6326@end defmac
6327
6328@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6329The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6330of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6331or a library call.  Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6332eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6333
6334The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6335optimized for speed rather than size.
6336
6337If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6338@end defmac
6339
6340@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6341A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6342to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6343will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6344than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6345@end defmac
6346
6347@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6348The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6349of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6350a block set insn or a library call.
6351Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6352eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6353
6354The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6355optimized for speed rather than size.
6356
6357If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6358@end defmac
6359
6360@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6361A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6362used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6363other mechanism will be used.  Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6364storing values other than constant zero.
6365Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6366than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6367@end defmac
6368
6369@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6370A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6371used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6372other mechanism will be used.  Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6373called with a constant source string.
6374Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6375than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6376@end defmac
6377
6378@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6379A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6380thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6381@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6382@end defmac
6383
6384@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6385A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6386thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6387@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6388@end defmac
6389
6390@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6391A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6392thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6393@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6394@end defmac
6395
6396@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6397A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6398thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6399@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6400@end defmac
6401
6402@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6403A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6404thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6405@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6406@end defmac
6407
6408@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6409A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6410thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6411@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6412@end defmac
6413
6414@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6415This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6416thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6417@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6418@end defmac
6419
6420@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6421This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6422thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6423@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6424@end defmac
6425
6426@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6427Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6428function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6429@end defmac
6430
6431@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6432Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6433@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal.  This macro defaults to true if
6434@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6435@end defmac
6436
6437@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6438This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6439
6440The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6441available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6442as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6443That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6444that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6445either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6446(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6447
6448@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6449obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6450
6451In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6452@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6453instructions.
6454
6455On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6456for the cost of the expression.  The hook should modify this value as
6457necessary.  Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6458for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6459operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6460
6461When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6462false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6463size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6464
6465The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6466processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6467@end deftypefn
6468
6469@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, bool @var{speed})
6470This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6471@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
6472the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6473
6474For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6475true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
6476instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
6477all addresses will have equal costs.
6478
6479In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6480the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6481cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6482
6483For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6484and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
6485is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6486references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
6487the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6488that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6489instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
6490specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6491
6492This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6493
6494On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6495cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6496@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6497be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6498@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect
6499should be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs
6500should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6501registers on machines with lots of registers.
6502@end deftypefn
6503
6504@node Scheduling
6505@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6506
6507The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6508adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
6509hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
6510them: try the first ones in this list first.
6511
6512@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6513This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6514issue at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.
6515Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6516an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6517constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6518hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6519This value must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need
6520it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6521@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6522@end deftypefn
6523
6524@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6525This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6526from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
6527still be issued in the current cycle.  The default is
6528@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6529@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6530You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6531than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6532@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6533debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6534@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the instruction that
6535was scheduled.
6536@end deftypefn
6537
6538@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6539This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6540relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6541dependence @var{link}.  It should return the new value.  The default
6542is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}.  This can be used for example
6543to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6544that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6545data-dependence.  If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6546description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6547output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6548times of the first and the second insns.  If these values are not
6549acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too.  See also
6550@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6551@end deftypefn
6552
6553@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6554This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6555@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Increase the priority to
6556execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6557later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6558scheduling priorities of insns.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
6561@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6562This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6563list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6564combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6565@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6566debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6567@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6568list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
6569a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
6570reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6571@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
6572is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
6573the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
6574can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
6575@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6576@end deftypefn
6577
6578@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6579Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
6580function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
6581is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6582@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6583return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
6584this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6585scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6586cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6587@end deftypefn
6588
6589@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6590This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6591chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6592correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain.  For
6593example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6594analysis of dependencies.  This hook can use backward and forward
6595dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6596calculated.
6597@end deftypefn
6598
6599@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6600This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6601instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
6602pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
6603is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6604@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6605region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
6606scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
6609@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6610This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6611instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
6612cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
6613is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6614to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6615@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6619This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6620@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6621@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6622@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6623@end deftypefn
6624
6625@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6626This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6627@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6628@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6629@end deftypefn
6630
6631@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6632The hook returns an RTL insn.  The automaton state used in the
6633pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6634when the new simulated processor cycle starts.  Usage of the hook may
6635simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6636processors.  If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6637based pipeline description.  The default is not to change the state
6638when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6639@end deftypefn
6640
6641@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6642The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6643@end deftypefn
6644
6645@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6646The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6647to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6648simulated processor cycle finishes.
6649@end deftypefn
6650
6651@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6652The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6653used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6654@end deftypefn
6655
6656@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6657The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6658The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6659to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6660state on a single insn is not enough.
6661@end deftypefn
6662
6663@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6664The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6665The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6666to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6667state on a single insn is not enough.
6668@end deftypefn
6669
6670@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6671This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6672for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler.  Usually the scheduler
6673chooses the first insn from the queue.  If the hook returns a positive
6674value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6675@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6676subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6677maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle.  For the
6678@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6679packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn.  Of course, if the
6680rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6681
6682This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6683processors.  Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6684with 3 pipelines.  Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6685@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6686@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}.  The
6687processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6688@var{B}.  In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6689until the next cycle.  If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6690the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6691
6692Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6693pipeline hazard recognizer.  We try quickly and easy many insn
6694schedules to choose the best one.
6695
6696The default is no multipass scheduling.
6697@end deftypefn
6698
6699@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6700
6701This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6702considered for the multipass insn scheduling.  If the hook returns
6703zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6704be issued.
6705
6706The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6710This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6711scheduling.
6712@end deftypefn
6713
6714@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6715This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6716@end deftypefn
6717
6718@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6719This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6720an instruction.
6721@end deftypefn
6722
6723@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6724This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6725round of multipass scheduling.
6726@end deftypefn
6727
6728@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6729This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6730@end deftypefn
6731
6732@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6733This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6734@end deftypefn
6735
6736@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6737This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6738on cycle @var{clock}.  If the hook returns nonzero,
6739@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle.  Instead,
6740the processor cycle is advanced.  If *@var{sort_p}
6741is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6742start as usually.  @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6743verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6744@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6745processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6746and the current processor cycle.
6747@end deftypefn
6748
6749@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6750This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6751the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6752are involved in the dependence too close to one another.  The parameters
6753to this hook are as follows:  The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6754being evaluated.  The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6755dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6756parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6757The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6758insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6759and @code{false} otherwise.
6760
6761Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6762where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6763delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6764that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6765important.  In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6766closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance;  however,
6767not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6768@end deftypefn
6769
6770@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6771This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6772the instruction stream.  The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6773per instruction data structures.
6774@end deftypefn
6775
6776@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6777Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6778@end deftypefn
6779
6780@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6781Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6782It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6783beginning of the block.  Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6784@end deftypefn
6785
6786@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6787Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6788@end deftypefn
6789
6790@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6791Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6792@end deftypefn
6793
6794@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6795Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6796@end deftypefn
6797
6798@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6799This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6800speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6801The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6802version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6803pattern.  The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6804or @minus{}1, if it doesn't.  @var{request} describes the type of requested
6805speculation.  If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6806the generated speculative pattern.
6807@end deftypefn
6808
6809@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6810This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6811for @var{insn}.  It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6812instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6813@end deftypefn
6814
6815@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6816This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6817check instruction.  If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6818speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6819@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6820be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6821recovery code (a simple check).  If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6822a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6823@var{insn} should be generated.  In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6824@end deftypefn
6825
6826@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6827This hook is used as a workaround for
6828@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6829called on the first instruction of the ready list.  The hook is used to
6830discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6831being scheduled on the current cycle.  If the hook returns @code{false},
6832@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6833For non-speculative instructions,
6834the hook should always return @code{true}.  For example, in the ia64 backend
6835the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6836is nearly full.
6837@end deftypefn
6838
6839@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6840This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6841enabled/used.
6842The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6843The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6844@end deftypefn
6845
6846@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6847This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6848resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6849the machine and the resources required by each instruction.  The target
6850backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound.  A very simple lower
6851bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6852of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6853@end deftypefn
6854
6855@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6856This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6857is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6858@end deftypefn
6859
6860@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6861This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It performs the operation specified
6862in its second parameter.
6863@end deftypefn
6864
6865@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6866True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6867the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6868also the latencies of operations.
6869@end deftypevr
6870
6871@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6872This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6873parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6874@end deftypefn
6875
6876@node Sections
6877@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6878@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
6879@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
6880
6881An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6882data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6883section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6884section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6885section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
6886of sections.
6887
6888@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6889@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6890The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6891is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6892as described below.  The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6893initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6894They may however depend on command-line flags.
6895
6896@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6897use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6898to be string literals.
6899
6900Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6901section is selected.  If your assembler falls into this category, you
6902should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6903@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6904
6905You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6906@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6907in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}.  The same is true of
6908@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  If you do not
6909create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6910reuse @code{text_section}.
6911
6912All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6913if the target does not provide them.
6914
6915@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6916A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6917assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6918Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6919@end defmac
6920
6921@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6922If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6923frequently executed functions of the program.  If not defined, GCC will provide
6924a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6925@end defmac
6926
6927@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6928If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6929executed functions in the program.
6930@end defmac
6931
6932@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6933A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6934assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6935data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6936@end defmac
6937
6938@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6939If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6940containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6941initialized, writable small data.
6942@end defmac
6943
6944@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6945A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6946assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6947data.
6948@end defmac
6949
6950@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6951If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6952containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6953uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and
6954@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6955uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6956@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6957used.
6958@end defmac
6959
6960@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6961If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6962containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6963uninitialized, writable small data.
6964@end defmac
6965
6966@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6967If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6968assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6969common data.  The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6970@end defmac
6971
6972@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6973If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6974containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section.  The
6975default is @code{'T'}.
6976@end defmac
6977
6978@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6979If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6980containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6981initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6982not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6983variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6984@end defmac
6985
6986@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6987If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6988containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6989finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6990not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6991variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6992@end defmac
6993
6994@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6995If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6996containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6997part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
6998defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
6999both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7000@end defmac
7001
7002@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7003If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7004containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7005part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
7006defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
7007both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7008@end defmac
7009
7010@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7011If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7012via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7013the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7014@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7015to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7016sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
7017ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7018registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7019constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7020@end defmac
7021
7022@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7023If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7024variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go.  This is useful
7025when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7026you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7027they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7028expects.  For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7029MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7030require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7031to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7032access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7033@end defmac
7034
7035@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7036If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7037arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
7038@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7039and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7040@end defmac
7041
7042@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7043Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7044tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7045section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
7046readonly data section is used.
7047
7048This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7049@end defmac
7050
7051@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7052Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7053@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7054of its own that you need to create.
7055
7056GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7057any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7058described below.
7059@end deftypefn
7060
7061@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7062Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7063selecting sections.  Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7064should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7065local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7066
7067The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7068is in effect, and 0 otherwise.  The hook is typically redefined
7069when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7070in read-only sections even in executables.
7071@end deftypefn
7072
7073@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7074Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed.  You can
7075assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7076some sort.  @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7077requires link-time relocations.  Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7078local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7079@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7080
7081The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7082variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7083
7084See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7085@end deftypefn
7086
7087@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7088Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7089for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7090
7091In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7092function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7093it is unlikely to be called.
7094@end defmac
7095
7096@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7097Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7098and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7099As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7100the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7101
7102The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7103ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol.  For
7104example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7105Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7106@end deftypefn
7107
7108@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7109Return the readonly data section associated with
7110@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7111The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7112the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7113if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7114otherwise.
7115@end deftypefn
7116
7117@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7118Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7119section names for mergeable constant data.  Define this macro to override
7120the string if a different section name should be used.
7121@end deftypevr
7122
7123@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7124Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone  tables.
7125@end deftypefn
7126
7127@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7128Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7129should be placed.  You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7130constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7131case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  @var{align} is the constant alignment
7132in bits.
7133
7134The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7135constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7136else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7137@end deftypefn
7138
7139@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7140Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7141by target-independent code.  The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7142the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7143or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++).  The return value of the
7144hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7145your target system.  The default implementation of this hook just
7146returns the @var{id} provided.
7147@end deftypefn
7148
7149@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7150Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7151treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7152function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7153
7154The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7155@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7156an entry in the constant pool.  In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7157rtl in question.  Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7158in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7159
7160In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7161a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}.  Most decls
7162will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed.  Global
7163register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7164rtl.  (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7165leave it alone.)
7166
7167The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7168that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl.  It will
7169be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7170declarations.  Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7171declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7172@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7173
7174@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7175The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7176@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7177Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7178encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7179discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7180
7181The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7182in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7183@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.  Check whether the default does what you need
7184before overriding it.
7185@end deftypefn
7186
7187@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7188Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7189the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7190may have added.
7191@end deftypefn
7192
7193@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7194Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7195The default version of this hook always returns false.
7196@end deftypefn
7197
7198@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7199Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7200``small data'' into a separate section.  The default value is false.
7201@end deftypevr
7202
7203@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7204It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7205
7206The default version of this hook use the target macro
7207@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7208@end deftypefn
7209
7210@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7211Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7212rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7213or executable image).
7214
7215The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7216for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7217currently supported object file formats.
7218@end deftypefn
7219
7220@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7221Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7222The default value is false.
7223@end deftypevr
7224
7225
7226@node PIC
7227@section Position Independent Code
7228@cindex position independent code
7229@cindex PIC
7230
7231This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7232independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7233generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7234@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7235@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You
7236must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7237when the source operand contains a symbolic address.  You may also
7238need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7239relative addresses.
7240@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7241@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7242
7243@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7244The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7245data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
7246processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
7247is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7248pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
7249is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7250necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7251when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7252@end defmac
7253
7254@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7255A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7256@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  If not defined,
7257the default is zero.  Do not define
7258this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7259@end defmac
7260
7261@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7262A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7263operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7264You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7265check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7266check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
7267(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7268position independent code.
7269@end defmac
7270
7271@node Assembler Format
7272@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7273
7274This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7275to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7276instructions do.
7277
7278@menu
7279* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
7280* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7281* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
7282* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
7283* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
7284                         and termination routines.
7285* Macros for Initialization::
7286                         Specific macros that control the handling of
7287                         initialization and termination routines.
7288* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
7289* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
7290* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7291* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7292@end menu
7293
7294@node File Framework
7295@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7296@cindex assembler format
7297@cindex output of assembler code
7298
7299@c prevent bad page break with this line
7300This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7301
7302@findex default_file_start
7303@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7304Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7305find at the beginning of a file.  The default behavior is controlled
7306by two flags, documented below.  Unless your target's assembler is
7307quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7308@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook.  This
7309lets other target files rely on these variables.
7310@end deftypefn
7311
7312@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7313If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7314printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7315@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect.  (If that macro has been defined
7316to the empty string, this variable has no effect.)  With the normal
7317definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7318assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7319whitespace from its input.  This allows it to work a bit faster.
7320
7321The default is false.  You should not set it to true unless you have
7322verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7323comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7324@end deftypevr
7325
7326@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7327If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7328for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7329@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled).  Most ELF assemblers expect
7330this to be done.  The default is false.
7331@end deftypevr
7332
7333@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7334Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7335to find at the end of a file.  The default is to output nothing.
7336@end deftypefn
7337
7338@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7339Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7340special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7341the stack being executable.  If your system uses this convention, you
7342should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function.  If you
7343need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7344this function.
7345@end deftypefun
7346
7347@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7348Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7349to find at the start of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7350nothing.
7351@end deftypefn
7352
7353@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7354Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7355to find at the end of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7356nothing.
7357@end deftypefn
7358
7359@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7360Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7361unwind info and debug info at the end of a file.  Some targets emit
7362here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7363because they couldn't have unwind info then.  The default is to output
7364nothing.
7365@end deftypefn
7366
7367@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7368A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7369assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7370the end of the line.
7371@end defmac
7372
7373@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7374A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7375statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7376@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7377assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7378that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7379@end defmac
7380
7381@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7382A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7383statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7384@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7385time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7386@end defmac
7387
7388@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7389A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7390which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7391the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7392
7393This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7394for the file format in use is appropriate.
7395@end defmac
7396
7397@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7398Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7399
7400 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7401@end deftypefn
7402
7403@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7404A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7405@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7406in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7407the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7408of the filename using this macro.
7409@end defmac
7410
7411@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7412A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7413@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
7414macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7415@end defmac
7416
7417@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7418Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
7419should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7420of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{decl}
7421is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7422this section is associated.
7423@end deftypefn
7424
7425@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7426Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7427Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7428functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7429at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7430@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7431(from static destructors).
7432Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7433@end deftypefn
7434
7435@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7436Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional  labels needed when a function is partitioned between different  sections.  Output should be written to @var{file}.  The function  decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if  @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7437@end deftypefn
7438
7439@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7440This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7441It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7442@end deftypevr
7443
7444@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7445@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7446This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7447section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7448This is true on most ELF targets.
7449@end deftypevr
7450
7451@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7452Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7453based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7454declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
7455null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7456
7457The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7458read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
7459need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7460set via @code{__attribute__}.
7461@end deftypefn
7462
7463@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7464Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7465switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7466enabled.  The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7467It can take the following values:
7468
7469@table @gcctabopt
7470@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7471@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7472
7473@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7474@var{text} is an option which has been enabled.  This might be as a
7475direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7476default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7477command line switch.  For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7478various different individual optimization passes.
7479
7480@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7481@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7482ignored.  If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7483target hook that either recording is starting or ending.  The first
7484time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7485warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7486wind down.  This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7487necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7488perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7489switches.
7490
7491@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7492This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7493
7494@item  SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7495This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7496@end table
7497
7498The hook's return value must be zero.  Other return values may be
7499supported in the future.
7500
7501By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7502provided for ELF based targets.  Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7503it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7504section in the assembler output file.  The name of the new section is
7505provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7506hook.
7507@end deftypefn
7508
7509@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7510This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7511ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7512hook.
7513@end deftypevr
7514
7515@need 2000
7516@node Data Output
7517@subsection Output of Data
7518
7519
7520@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7521@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7522@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7523@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7524@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7525@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7526@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7527@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7528@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7529These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7530of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7531byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7532aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
7533@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7534
7535The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7536followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
7537the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7538@end deftypevr
7539
7540@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7541The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7542integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7543in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
7544function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7545object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7546split the object into smaller parts.
7547
7548The default implementation of this hook will use the
7549@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7550when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7551@end deftypefn
7552
7553@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7554A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7555can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7556the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7557@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7558
7559If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7560so that a standard error message is printed.  If it prints an error message
7561itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7562return @code{true}.
7563@end deftypefn
7564
7565@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7566A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7567instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7568bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7569@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7570
7571If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7572Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7573@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7574@end defmac
7575
7576@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7577A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7578@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7579is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7580@end defmac
7581
7582@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7583You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
7584expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7585pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7586GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
7587not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7588pool before the function.
7589@end defmac
7590
7591@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7592A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7593constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
7594the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
7595be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
7596is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7597immediately after this call.
7598
7599If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7600not be defined.
7601@end defmac
7602
7603@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7604A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7605constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
7606anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7607
7608The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7609assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7610output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7611@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7612@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7613alignment.
7614
7615The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7616the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
7617responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7618Here is how to do this:
7619
7620@smallexample
7621@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7622@end smallexample
7623
7624When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7625@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
7626entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7627
7628You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7629@end defmac
7630
7631@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7632A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7633pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7634function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7635obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7636constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7637
7638If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7639define this macro.
7640@end defmac
7641
7642@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7643Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7644used as a logical line separator by the assembler.  @var{STR} points
7645to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7646a line separator uses multiple characters.
7647
7648If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7649the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7650@end defmac
7651
7652@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7653@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7654These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7655assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
7656default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7657@end deftypevr
7658
7659These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7660of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7661
7662@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7663@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7664@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7665@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7666@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7667@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7668These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7669target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7670the variable @var{l}.  For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7671@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7672simple @code{long int}.  For the others, it should be an array of
7673@code{long int}.  The number of elements in this array is determined
7674by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7675it go in each @code{long int} array element.  Each array element holds
767632 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7677on the host machine.
7678
7679The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7680using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7681machine's memory.
7682@end defmac
7683
7684@node Uninitialized Data
7685@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7686
7687Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7688outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7689
7690@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7691A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7692@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7693@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
7694is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.  It is
7695possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7696other member than a zero-length array is defined.  In this case, the
7697backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7698byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7699equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7700the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7701an ordinary undefined external.
7702
7703Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7704output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7705assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7706
7707This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7708common global variables are output.
7709@end defmac
7710
7711@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7712Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7713separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
7714place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7715handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
7716as the number of bits.
7717@end defmac
7718
7719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7720Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7721variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7722is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7723in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7724@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
7725the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7726@end defmac
7727
7728@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7729A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7730@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7731@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{alignment}
7732is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7733
7734Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7735@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
7736@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7737before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7738the name, and a newline.
7739
7740There are two ways of handling global BSS@.  One is to define this macro.
7741The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7742switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7743You do not need to do both.
7744
7745Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7746non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7747efficiently.  C++ is one example of this.  However, if the target does
7748not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7749common in order to save space in the object file.
7750@end defmac
7751
7752@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7753A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7754@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7755@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
7756is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7757
7758Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7759output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7760assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7761
7762This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7763static variables are output.
7764@end defmac
7765
7766@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7767Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7768separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
7769place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7770handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
7771as the number of bits.
7772@end defmac
7773
7774@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7775Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7776variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7777is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7778in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7779@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
7780the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7781@end defmac
7782
7783@node Label Output
7784@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7785
7786@c prevent bad page break with this line
7787This is about outputting labels.
7788
7789@findex assemble_name
7790@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7791A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7792@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7793Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7794output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7795assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
7796definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7797@end defmac
7798
7799@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7800A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7801@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7802a function.
7803Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7804output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7805assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
7806definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7807
7808If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7809usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7810@end defmac
7811
7812@findex assemble_name_raw
7813@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7814Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7815to refer to a compiler-generated label.  The default definition uses
7816@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7817that it is more efficient.
7818@end defmac
7819
7820@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7821A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7822size of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
7823default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7824systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7825
7826Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7827of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7828for your system.  If you need your own custom definitions of those
7829macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7830define this macro.
7831@end defmac
7832
7833@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7834A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7835@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7836symbol @var{name} is @var{size}.  @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7837If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7838provided.
7839@end defmac
7840
7841@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7842A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7843@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7844the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7845address.
7846
7847If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7848provided.  The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7849@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7850the difference between this and another symbol.  If your assembler does
7851not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7852to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7853@end defmac
7854
7855@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7856A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7857type of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
7858default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7859systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7860
7861Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7862@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
7863custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7864types at all, do not define this macro.
7865@end defmac
7866
7867@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7868A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7869the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}.  On systems that use ELF, the
7870default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7871the default is not to define this macro.
7872
7873Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7874@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
7875custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7876types at all, do not define this macro.
7877@end defmac
7878
7879@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7880A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7881@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7882symbol @var{name} is @var{type}.  @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7883that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7884you should not count on this.
7885
7886If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7887definition of this macro is provided.
7888@end defmac
7889
7890@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7891A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7892@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7893function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
7894outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7895@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
7896@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7897
7898If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7899usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7900
7901You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7902of this macro.
7903@end defmac
7904
7905@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7906A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7907@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7908which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7909function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7910representing the function.
7911
7912If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7913
7914You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7915of this macro.
7916@end defmac
7917
7918@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7919A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7920@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7921initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
7922label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
7923@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7924
7925If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7926usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7927
7928You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7929@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7930@end defmac
7931
7932@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7933A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7934for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined.  This
7935target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7936@code{assemble_label}).  The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7937and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes.  The @var{name}
7938will be an internal label.
7939
7940The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7941usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7942
7943You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7944@end deftypefn
7945
7946@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7947A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7948@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7949for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7950
7951If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7952nothing.
7953@end defmac
7954
7955@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7956A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7957once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7958chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7959initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7960something about the size of the object.
7961
7962If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7963nothing.
7964
7965You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7966@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7967@end defmac
7968
7969@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7970This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7971@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7972that is, available for reference from other files.
7973
7974The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7975@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7976@end deftypefn
7977
7978@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7979This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7980@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7981global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7982
7983The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7984@end deftypefn
7985
7986@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7987A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7988@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7989that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7990no other definition is available.  Use the expression
7991@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7992itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7993for making that name weak, and a newline.
7994
7995If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7996support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7997macro.
7998@end defmac
7999
8000@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8001Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8002@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8003or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8004should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8005defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8006@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8007to make @var{name} weak.
8008@end defmac
8009
8010@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8011Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8012symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics.  @code{decl} is the
8013declaration of @code{name}.
8014@end defmac
8015
8016@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8017A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8018supports weak symbols.
8019
8020If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8021definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8022is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8023@end defmac
8024
8025@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8026A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8027
8028If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8029definition.  The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}.  Define
8030this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8031flag such as @option{-melf}.
8032@end defmac
8033
8034@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8035A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8036public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8037be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
8038format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8039section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8040requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8041@end defmac
8042
8043@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8044A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8045semantics.
8046
8047If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8048definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8049definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
8050you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8051setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8052be emitted as one-only.
8053@end defmac
8054
8055@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8056This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8057commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8058hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8059@end deftypefn
8060
8061@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8062A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8063that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8064The default is @code{0}.
8065
8066Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8067if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8068will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8069symbol should not be weak.  Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8070thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8071(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8072with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8073
8074The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero.  Define this macro for
8075targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8076restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8077table of contents.
8078@end defmac
8079
8080@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8081A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8082@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8083symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8084not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8085declaration.
8086
8087This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8088The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8089@end defmac
8090
8091@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8092This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8093pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
8094library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8095@end deftypefn
8096
8097@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8098This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8099directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used.  The Darwin target uses the
8100.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8101@end deftypefn
8102
8103@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8104A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8105@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8106@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8107is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8108systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8109@end defmac
8110
8111@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8112Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}.  Required for correct LTO symtabs.  The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8113@end deftypefn
8114
8115@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8116A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8117@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8118will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
8119to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8120encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8121@end defmac
8122
8123@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8124A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8125result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.  If not defined,
8126@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8127This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8128specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8129when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8130being taken.
8131@end defmac
8132
8133@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8134A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8135name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8136
8137It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8138used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
8139will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8140
8141It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8142object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8143should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8144beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
8145convention your system uses, and follow it.
8146
8147The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8148@end deftypefn
8149
8150@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8151A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8152label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8153@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8154may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
8155systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8156bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8157bundles.
8158
8159If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8160used.
8161@end defmac
8162
8163@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8164A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8165is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8166
8167This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8168produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8169with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8170
8171If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8172output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
8173@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
8174string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8175to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
8176@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8177you should know what it does on your machine.)
8178@end defmac
8179
8180@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8181A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8182@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8183@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8184added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8185
8186The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8187produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8188@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8189assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8190macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8191internal static variables in different scopes.
8192
8193Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8194conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
8195or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8196between the name and the number will suffice.
8197
8198If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8199which is correct for most systems.
8200@end defmac
8201
8202@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8203A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8204which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8205
8206@findex SET_ASM_OP
8207If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8208correct for most systems.
8209@end defmac
8210
8211@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8212A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8213which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8214to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
8215be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8216the tree nodes are available.
8217
8218@findex SET_ASM_OP
8219If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8220correct for most systems.
8221@end defmac
8222
8223@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8224A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8225(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8226of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8227current compilation unit.  The default is to not defer output of defines.
8228This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8229@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8230@end defmac
8231
8232@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8233A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8234which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8235@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8236an undefined weak symbol.
8237
8238Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8239@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8240@end defmac
8241
8242@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8243Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8244Objective-C methods.
8245
8246The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8247class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
8248the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8249@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8250
8251These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8252the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
8253systems define other ways of computing names.
8254
8255@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8256buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8257@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
825850 characters extra.
8259
8260The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8261method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8262@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8263in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8264
8265On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8266macro to provide more human-readable names.
8267@end defmac
8268
8269@node Initialization
8270@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8271@cindex initialization routines
8272@cindex termination routines
8273@cindex constructors, output of
8274@cindex destructors, output of
8275
8276The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8277(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8278data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
8279to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8280@code{main} is called.
8281
8282Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8283@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8284terminates.
8285
8286To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8287must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8288be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
8289system, you need to specify how to do this.
8290
8291There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8292initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
8293Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8294
8295@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8296@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8297The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8298initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8299termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8300
8301Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
83020, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8303the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8304pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8305pointer containing zero.
8306
8307Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8308@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8309time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8310list; destructors in forward order.
8311
8312The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8313formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
8314aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8315Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
8316object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8317the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
8318accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8319Termination functions are handled similarly.
8320
8321This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8322@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
8323support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8324constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8325and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8326
8327When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8328upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
8329support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8330parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
8331program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8332
8333@smallexample
8334ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8335@end smallexample
8336
8337The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8338section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
8339for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
8340files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8341are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8342
8343The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8344compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
8345fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8346to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
8347of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8348that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8349
8350To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8351macro properly.
8352
8353If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8354@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8355entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8356it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8357after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
8358in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8359
8360In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8361two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8362and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
8363@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8364entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8365and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8366code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8367the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8368placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8369a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8370@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
8371section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8372the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8373the initialization process.
8374
8375The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8376This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8377file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
8378this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8379termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
8380an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
8381pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8382the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8383initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
8384via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
8385@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8386
8387@ifinfo
8388The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8389customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8390@end ifinfo
8391
8392@node Macros for Initialization
8393@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8394
8395Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8396and termination functions:
8397
8398@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8399If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8400operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
8401defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
8402using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8403macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8404run the initialization functions.
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8408If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8409This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8410on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8411be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8412@end defmac
8413
8414@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8415If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8416the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8417@end defmac
8418
8419@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8420If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8421the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8422@end defmac
8423
8424@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8425If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8426automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
8427should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8428the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8429function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8430
8431This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8432shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8433exception tables embedded in the code.
8434@end defmac
8435
8436@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8437If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8438automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
8439should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8440the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8441function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8442@end defmac
8443
8444@defmac INVOKE__main
8445If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8446@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
8447where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8448useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8449@end defmac
8450
8451@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8452If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8453compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8454of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8455encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8456@end defmac
8457
8458@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8459This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8460collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8461It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8462@end deftypevr
8463
8464@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8465If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8466the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8467
8468Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8469no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
8470priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8471otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8472
8473If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8474be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8475target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8476is not defined.
8477@end deftypefn
8478
8479@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8480This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8481functions rather than initialization functions.
8482@end deftypefn
8483
8484If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8485generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8486
8487If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8488constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8489an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8490
8491On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8492@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8493
8494@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8495Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8496object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8497object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8498
8499This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8500part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8501@end defmac
8502
8503@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8504Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8505to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
8506@command{nm}.
8507@end defmac
8508
8509@defmac NM_FLAGS
8510@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8511constructors and destructors and LTO info.  By default, @option{-n} is
8512passed.  Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8513are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8514produces.
8515@end defmac
8516
8517If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8518dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8519these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8520termination functions in shared libraries:
8521
8522@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8523Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8524which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8525@end defmac
8526
8527@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8528Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8529of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
8530of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8531from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8532code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8533line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8534@end defmac
8535
8536@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8537Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8538library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}).  @command{collect2}
8539strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8540constructor and destructor names.  This define is only needed on targets
8541that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8542@end defmac
8543
8544@node Instruction Output
8545@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8546
8547@c prevent bad page break with this line
8548This describes assembler instruction output.
8549
8550@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8551A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8552registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
8553register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8554@end defmac
8555
8556@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8557If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8558and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
8559registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8560to registers using alternate names.
8561@end defmac
8562
8563@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8564If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8565name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8566machine registers the name overlaps.  This macro defines additional
8567names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8568declarations to refer to registers using alternate names.  Unlike
8569@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8570register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8571
8572This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8573@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8574register name.  For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8575VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8576``s0'' and ``s1''.
8577@end defmac
8578
8579@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8580Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8581requires different names for the machine instructions.
8582
8583The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8584assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
8585macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8586points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8587written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
8588opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8589increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8590so that it will not be output twice.
8591
8592In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8593name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8594that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8595care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
8596@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8597
8598@findex recog_data.operand
8599If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8600elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8601
8602If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8603in the usual way.
8604@end defmac
8605
8606@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8607If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8608assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8609they will be output differently.
8610
8611Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8612extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8613elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8614The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8615template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8616by changing the contents of the vector.
8617
8618This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8619file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8620can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8621as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
8622syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8623writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8624
8625If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8626@end defmac
8627
8628@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8629If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8630output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8631if necessary.
8632
8633Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8634extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8635elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8636The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8637template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8638by checking the contents of the vector.
8639@end deftypefn
8640
8641@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8642A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8643assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
8644RTL expression.
8645
8646@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8647of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
8648printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
8649the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8650operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8651@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8652@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8653
8654@findex reg_names
8655If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8656The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8657@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8658@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8659
8660When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8661(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8662with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8663@var{code}.
8664@end defmac
8665
8666@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8667A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8668punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
8669@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8670punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8671in this way.
8672@end defmac
8673
8674@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8675A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8676assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8677whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8678
8679@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8680On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8681section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the hook
8682@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8683@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler
8684Format}.
8685@end defmac
8686
8687@findex dbr_sequence_length
8688@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8689A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8690been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8691determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8692currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8693or whatever.
8694
8695Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8696reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8697explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8698@end defmac
8699
8700@findex final_sequence
8701Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8702prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8703(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8704found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8705processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8706being output.
8707
8708@findex asm_fprintf
8709@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8710@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8711@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8712@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8713If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8714@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8715@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8716support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8717files can define these macros differently.
8718@end defmac
8719
8720@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8721If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8722statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8723the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
8724printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8725statements.  Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8726generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8727specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8728The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8729string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8730upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8731@end defmac
8732
8733@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8734If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8735different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8736numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8737first variant.
8738
8739If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8740@smallexample
8741@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8742@end smallexample
8743@noindent
8744in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8745first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
8746@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8747@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
8748within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
8749alternatives within the braces than the value of
8750@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8751
8752If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8753@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8754operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8755
8756Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8757@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8758the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
8759@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8760if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8761opcodes or operand order.
8762@end defmac
8763
8764@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8765A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8766which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8767The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8768profiling.
8769@end defmac
8770
8771@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8772A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8773which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8774The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8775profiling.
8776@end defmac
8777
8778@node Dispatch Tables
8779@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8780
8781@c prevent bad page break with this line
8782This concerns dispatch tables.
8783
8784@cindex dispatch table
8785@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8786A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8787pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8788@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
8789definitions of these labels are output using
8790@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8791way here.  For example,
8792
8793@smallexample
8794fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8795         @var{value}, @var{rel})
8796@end smallexample
8797
8798You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8799dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
8800will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8801@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8802mode and flags can be read.
8803@end defmac
8804
8805@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8806This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8807in a dispatch table are absolute.
8808
8809The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8810@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8811a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8812definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8813For example,
8814
8815@smallexample
8816fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8817@end smallexample
8818@end defmac
8819
8820@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8821Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8822specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
8823@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8824jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8825@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8826
8827This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8828for the table.
8829
8830If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8831@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8832@end defmac
8833
8834@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8835Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8836jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8837after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
8838the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
8839@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8840of the preceding label.
8841
8842If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8843the jump-table.
8844@end defmac
8845
8846@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8847This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@.  It
8848should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8849should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8850function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8851The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8852exception table.  The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8853true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8854
8855The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8856@end deftypefn
8857
8858@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8859This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8860It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8861to be broken up according to function.
8862
8863The default is that no label is emitted.
8864@end deftypefn
8865
8866@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8867If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info.  This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8868@end deftypefn
8869
8870@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8871This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8872given instruction.  This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8873returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8874@end deftypefn
8875
8876@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8877True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8878@end deftypevr
8879
8880@node Exception Region Output
8881@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8882
8883@c prevent bad page break with this line
8884
8885This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8886region.
8887
8888@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8889If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8890exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
8891provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8892@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8893
8894You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8895unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8896@end defmac
8897
8898@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8899If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8900data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
8901might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8902collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8903
8904Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8905also defined.
8906@end defmac
8907
8908@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8909Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8910information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8911runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8912and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8913@end defmac
8914
8915@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8916An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8917that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8918@end defmac
8919
8920@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8921Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8922information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8923Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8924@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8925or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8926@end defmac
8927
8928@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8929This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8930by the target.  If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8931should return @code{UI_TARGET}.  If the target is to use the
8932@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8933should return @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8934information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8935
8936A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8937This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code.  The
8938default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8939
8940Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant.  It should
8941not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8942@var{opts}.  In particular, the
8943setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8944macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8945depending on this setting.
8946
8947The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8948@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8949@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If
8950@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8951must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8952@end deftypefn
8953
8954@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8955This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8956tables even when exceptions are not used.  It must not be modified by
8957command-line option processing.
8958@end deftypevr
8959
8960@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8961Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8962should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8963instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8964@end defmac
8965
8966@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8967This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8968function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8969@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
8970alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8971minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
8972the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8973@end defmac
8974
8975@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8976Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8977end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8978Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8979true otherwise.
8980@end deftypevr
8981
8982@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8983Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8984represent where to find the register pieces.  Define this hook if the
8985register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8986locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8987register in Dwarf.  Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8988If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8989@end deftypefn
8990
8991@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8992If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8993multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8994sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8995It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8996filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8997@var{address} is the address of the table.
8998@end deftypefn
8999
9000@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9001This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9002the type_info object identified by @var{sym}.  It should return @code{true}
9003if the reference was output.  Returning @code{false} will cause the
9004reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9005@end deftypefn
9006
9007@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9008This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9009based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets.  This effects
9010the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9011running a cleanup.  The default is @code{false}.
9012@end deftypevr
9013
9014@node Alignment Output
9015@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9016
9017@c prevent bad page break with this line
9018This describes commands for alignment.
9019
9020@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9021The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9022a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9023
9024This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9025to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9026define the macro.
9027
9028Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9029to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9030@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9031selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9032@end defmac
9033
9034@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9035The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9036@code{JUMP_ALIGN}.  This works only if
9037@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9038@end deftypefn
9039
9040@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9041The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9042a @code{BARRIER}.
9043
9044This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9045to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9046define the macro.
9047@end defmac
9048
9049@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9050The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9051@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
9052@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9053@end deftypefn
9054
9055@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9056The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9057a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9058
9059This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9060to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9061define the macro.
9062
9063Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9064to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9065@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9066selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9067@end defmac
9068
9069@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9070The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9071@var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9072defined.
9073@end deftypefn
9074
9075@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9076The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9077If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9078the maximum of the specified values is used.
9079
9080Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9081to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9082@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9083selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9084@end defmac
9085
9086@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9087The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9088to @var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9089is defined.
9090@end deftypefn
9091
9092@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9093A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9094instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9095Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
9096expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9097@end defmac
9098
9099@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9100Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9101text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9102This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9103produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9104section.
9105@end defmac
9106
9107@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9108A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9109command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9110@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9111@end defmac
9112
9113@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9114Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9115for padding, if necessary.
9116@end defmac
9117
9118@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9119A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9120command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9121@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9122satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9123a C expression of type @code{int}.
9124@end defmac
9125
9126@need 3000
9127@node Debugging Info
9128@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9129
9130@c prevent bad page break with this line
9131This describes how to specify debugging information.
9132
9133@menu
9134* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9135* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9136* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9137* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9138* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9139* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
9140@end menu
9141
9142@node All Debuggers
9143@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9144
9145@c prevent bad page break with this line
9146These macros affect all debugging formats.
9147
9148@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9149A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9150register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
9151of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
9152some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9153versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9154compiler and another for DBX@.
9155
9156If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9157used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9158consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9159Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9160expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9161
9162If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9163does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9164redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9165@end defmac
9166
9167@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9168A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9169variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
9170computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9171gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
9172that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9173for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9174@option{-g} options is used.
9175@end defmac
9176
9177@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9178A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9179having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
9180@var{offset}.
9181@end defmac
9182
9183@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9184A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9185produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
9186this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9187debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9188@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9189@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9190
9191When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9192value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9193exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9194value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9195defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9196
9197The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9198user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9199@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9200@end defmac
9201
9202@node DBX Options
9203@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9204
9205@c prevent bad page break with this line
9206These are specific options for DBX output.
9207
9208@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9209Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9210in response to the @option{-g} option.
9211@end defmac
9212
9213@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9214Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9215in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
9216@end defmac
9217
9218@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9219Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9220GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9221debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
9222macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9223if there is any occasion to.
9224@end defmac
9225
9226@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9227Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9228in the text section.
9229@end defmac
9230
9231@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9232A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9233use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9234If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
9235applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9236@end defmac
9237
9238@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9239A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9240use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9241value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
9242@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9243information format.
9244@end defmac
9245
9246@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9247A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9248use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9249name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
9250macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9251@end defmac
9252
9253@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9254Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9255@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
9256describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9257On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9258@end defmac
9259
9260@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9261A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9262continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9263exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
9264operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9265must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9266with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
9267defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9268@end defmac
9269
9270@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9271Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9272the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
9273a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9274constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
9275if backslash is correct for your system.
9276@end defmac
9277
9278@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9279Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9280outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9281variable.
9282@end defmac
9283
9284@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9285The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9286for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9287@end defmac
9288
9289@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9290The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9291for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
9292provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9293@end defmac
9294
9295@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9296The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9297for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
9298``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9299@end defmac
9300
9301@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9302The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9303passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9304do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
9305@end defmac
9306
9307@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9308Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9309arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
9310in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9311code.
9312@end defmac
9313
9314@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9315Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9316the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9317relative to the start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses
9318an absolute address.
9319@end defmac
9320
9321@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9322Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9323the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9324start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9325@end defmac
9326
9327@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9328Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9329@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
9330macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9331number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
9332generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9333number for a type number.
9334@end defmac
9335
9336@node DBX Hooks
9337@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9338
9339@c prevent bad page break with this line
9340These are hooks for DBX format.
9341
9342@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9343Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9344information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
9345argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9346@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9347@end defmac
9348
9349@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9350Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9351@end defmac
9352
9353@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9354Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9355output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9356@end defmac
9357
9358@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9359A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9360number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9361@var{stream}.  @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9362invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9363unique labels in the assembly output.
9364
9365This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9366if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9367@end defmac
9368
9369@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9370Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9371@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9372On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9373disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9374@end defmac
9375
9376@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9377Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9378extension construct.  On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9379feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9380@end defmac
9381
9382@node File Names and DBX
9383@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9384
9385@c prevent bad page break with this line
9386This describes file names in DBX format.
9387
9388@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9389A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9390@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9391file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9392This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9393
9394This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9395for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9396
9397It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9398text section.  You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9399to do so.  If you do this, you must also set the variable
9400@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9401@end defmac
9402
9403@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9404Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9405of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9406the beginning of the file.
9407@end defmac
9408
9409@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9410Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9411that this object file was compiled by GCC@.  The default is to emit
9412an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9413@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9414@end defmac
9415
9416@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9417A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9418compilation of the main source file @var{name}.  Output should be
9419written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9420
9421If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9422of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9423@end defmac
9424
9425@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9426Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9427@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9428the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9429whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9430@end defmac
9431
9432@need 2000
9433@node SDB and DWARF
9434@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9435
9436@c prevent bad page break with this line
9437Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9438
9439@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9440Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9441for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9442@end defmac
9443
9444@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9445Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9446debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9447
9448@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9449Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9450be emitted for each function.  Instead of an integer return the enum
9451value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9452@end deftypefn
9453
9454To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9455define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9456@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9457prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9458as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9459@end defmac
9460
9461@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9462Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9463Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9464(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9465exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9466how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9467@end defmac
9468
9469@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9470This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9471unwind information to the debugger.  Normally the hook will return
9472@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9473return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9474
9475A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9476is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9477
9478A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9479This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9480@end deftypefn
9481
9482@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9483Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9484line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
9485tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9486@end defmac
9487
9488@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9489True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted.  These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9490@end deftypevr
9491
9492@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9493True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each  compilation unit.  This attribute is required for the darwin linker  to emit debug information.
9494@end deftypevr
9495
9496@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9497True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.  This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9498@end deftypevr
9499
9500@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9501True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.  This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9502@end deftypevr
9503
9504@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9505A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9506@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9507@end defmac
9508
9509@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9510A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9511between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9512slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9513@end defmac
9514
9515@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9516A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9517section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9518given @var{size}.  The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9519@end defmac
9520
9521@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9522A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9523reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9524@end defmac
9525
9526@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9527A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9528the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section.  This
9529is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9530is referenced by a function.
9531@end defmac
9532
9533@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9534If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9535reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9536@end deftypefn
9537
9538@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9539Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9540SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9541macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
9542not define them yourself.
9543@end defmac
9544
9545@defmac SDB_DELIM
9546Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9547SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
9548delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
9549a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9550required.
9551@end defmac
9552
9553@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9554Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9555union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
9556allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9557it.
9558@end defmac
9559
9560@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9561Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9562enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
9563assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9564@end defmac
9565
9566@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9567A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9568number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9569@var{stream}.  The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9570@end defmac
9571
9572@need 2000
9573@node VMS Debug
9574@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9575
9576@c prevent bad page break with this line
9577Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9578
9579@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9580Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9581in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
9582is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9583@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
9584behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9585@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9586@end defmac
9587
9588@node Floating Point
9589@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9590@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9591@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9592
9593While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9594there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
9595means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9596in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9597doing the compilation.
9598
9599Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9600range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9601the target machine's format.  Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9602safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9603the target's arithmetic.  To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9604emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9605target floating point formats are identical.
9606
9607The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9608use.  All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9609floating-point calculations must use these macros.  They may evaluate
9610their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9611
9612@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9613The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9614machine's format.  Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9615array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9616quantity.
9617@end defmac
9618
9619@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9620Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}.  If the target
9621floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9622@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9623@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9624@end deftypefn
9625
9626@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9627Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9628@end deftypefn
9629
9630@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9631Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9632@end deftypefn
9633
9634@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9635Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero.  If
9636@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9637@end deftypefn
9638
9639@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9640Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9641representation for mode @var{mode}.  This routine can handle both
9642decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9643defined by the C language for both.
9644@end deftypefn
9645
9646@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9647Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9648@end deftypefn
9649
9650@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9651Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9652@end deftypefn
9653
9654@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9655Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9656@end deftypefn
9657
9658@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9659Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9660@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9661variable).
9662
9663The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}.  Only the
9664following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9665@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9666
9667If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9668target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9669@code{abort}.  Callers should check for this situation first, using
9670@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}.  @xref{Storage Layout}.
9671@end deftypefn
9672
9673@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9674Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9675@end deftypefn
9676
9677@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9678Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9679@end deftypefn
9680
9681@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9682Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}.  The
9683return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9684appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9685precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9686@end deftypefn
9687
9688@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9689Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9690which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}.  If the value is not
9691integral, it is truncated.
9692@end deftypefn
9693
9694@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9695Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9696into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.  The
9697value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9698@end deftypefn
9699
9700@node Mode Switching
9701@section Mode Switching Instructions
9702@cindex mode switching
9703The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9704
9705@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9706Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9707switching in an optimizing compilation.
9708
9709For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9710floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9711the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9712operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
9713purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9714be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9715or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9716
9717You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9718which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9719return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9720If you define this macro, you also have to define
9721@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9722@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9723@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9724are optional.
9725@end defmac
9726
9727@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9728If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9729initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
9730N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9731of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9732The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9733zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9734entity in question.
9735In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9736represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
9737switch is needed / supplied.
9738@end defmac
9739
9740@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9741@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
9742@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9743return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9744@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9745be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9746@end defmac
9747
9748@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9749If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9750mode switching.  It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9751different from the incoming mode).
9752@end defmac
9753
9754@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9755If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9756mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9757@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry.  If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9758is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9759@end defmac
9760
9761@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9762If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9763mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9764@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit.  If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9765is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9766@end defmac
9767
9768@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9769This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
97700 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9771lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9772for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9773(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9774@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9775@end defmac
9776
9777@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9778Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9779@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9780the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9781@end defmac
9782
9783@node Target Attributes
9784@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9785@cindex target attributes
9786@cindex machine attributes
9787@cindex attributes, target-specific
9788
9789Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9790These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9791be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9792
9793@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9794If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9795attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9796specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9797entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9798take.
9799@end deftypevr
9800
9801@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9802If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9803machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9804given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9805subjected to name lookup.  If this is not defined, the default is
9806false for all machine-specific attributes.
9807@end deftypefn
9808
9809@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9810If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9811@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9812and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9813generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9814supposed always to be compatible.
9815@end deftypefn
9816
9817@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9818If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9819the newly defined @var{type}.
9820@end deftypefn
9821
9822@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9823Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9824handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9825@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
9826that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
9827function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9828merging.
9829@end deftypefn
9830
9831@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9832Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9833handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9834@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9835@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
9836when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9837attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
9838call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9839
9840@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9841If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9842for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9843@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}.  The compiler
9844will then define a function called
9845@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9846the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  You can also
9847add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9848to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9849@samp{dllexport} attributes.  This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9850@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9851@end deftypefn
9852
9853@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9854@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified.  Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9855@end deftypefn
9856
9857@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9858Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9859@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}.  By
9860default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9861@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  The current implementation
9862of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9863on this implementation detail.
9864@end defmac
9865
9866@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9867Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9868when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
9869wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9870the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9871created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9872for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9873shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9874the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9875attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9876needed.
9877@end deftypefn
9878
9879@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9880@cindex inlining
9881This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9882into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9883attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
9884target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9885@end deftypefn
9886
9887@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9888This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9889it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9890options for the current function that might be different than the
9891options specified on the command line.  The hook should return
9892@code{true} if the options are valid.
9893
9894The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9895the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9896@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9897@end deftypefn
9898
9899@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9900This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9901in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9902options.
9903@xref{Option file format}.
9904@end deftypefn
9905
9906@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9907This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9908information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9909function specific options.
9910@end deftypefn
9911
9912@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9913This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9914information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9915function specific options.
9916@end deftypefn
9917
9918@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9919This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9920set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9921input stream.  The options should be the same as handled by the
9922@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9923@end deftypefn
9924
9925@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9926Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9927a particular target machine.  You can override the hook
9928@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this.  This hooks is called
9929once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9930
9931Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9932@option{-O}.  That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9933
9934If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9935changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9936@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9937@end deftypefn
9938
9939@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9940This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9941cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information.  By
9942default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9943specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9944@end deftypefn
9945
9946@node Emulated TLS
9947@section Emulating TLS
9948@cindex Emulated TLS
9949
9950For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9951specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9952used.  A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9953configured for the requirements of a particular target.  For instance
9954the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9955layer.
9956
9957The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9958object.  To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9959which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9960address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9961
9962@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9963Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9964object to locate a TLS instance.  The default causes libgcc's
9965emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9966@end deftypevr
9967
9968@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9969Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9970program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9971initialized to zero.  If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9972have explicit initializers.  The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9973registration function to be used.
9974@end deftypevr
9975
9976@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9977Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9978be placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9979any section.
9980@end deftypevr
9981
9982@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9983Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9984placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9985section.
9986@end deftypevr
9987
9988@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9989Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9990The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9991@end deftypevr
9992
9993@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9994Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects.  The
9995default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9996@end deftypevr
9997
9998@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9999Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10000object type.  @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10001@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10002@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable.  The default creates a type suitable
10003for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10004@end deftypefn
10005
10006@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10007Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10008TLS control object.  @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10009is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10010initializer.  The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10011@end deftypefn
10012
10013@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10014Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10015fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10016single objects.  The default is false.
10017@end deftypevr
10018
10019@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10020Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10021may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10022@end deftypevr
10023
10024@node MIPS Coprocessors
10025@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10026@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10027
10028The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10029coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers.  GCC supports
10030accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10031and memory using asm-ized variables.  For example:
10032
10033@smallexample
10034  register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10035  unsigned int d;
10036
10037  d = cp0count + 3;
10038@end smallexample
10039
10040(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10041names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10042overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10043
10044Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10045be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10046later in the function.
10047
10048Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10049the FPU@.  One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10050floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10051
10052There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10053you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10054
10055@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
10056A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
10057alternate names of coprocessor registers.  The format of each entry should be
10058@smallexample
10059@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
10060@end smallexample
10061Default: empty.
10062@end defmac
10063
10064@node PCH Target
10065@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10066@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10067
10068@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10069This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10070@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10071@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10072@end deftypefn
10073
10074@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10075This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10076compatible with the current settings.  It returns @code{NULL}
10077if so and a suitable error message if not.  Error messages will
10078be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10079
10080@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10081when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10082It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10083compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10084
10085The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10086suitable for most targets.
10087@end deftypefn
10088
10089@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10090If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10091@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10092of @code{target_flags}.  @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10093@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created.  The return
10094value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10095@end deftypefn
10096
10097@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10098Called before writing out a PCH file.  If the target has some
10099garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10100it can use this hook to enforce that state.  Very few targets need
10101to do anything here.
10102@end deftypefn
10103
10104@node C++ ABI
10105@section C++ ABI parameters
10106@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10107
10108@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10109Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10110These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects.  The
10111default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10112@end deftypefn
10113
10114@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10115This hook determines how guard variables are used.  It should return
10116@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used.  A return value of
10117@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10118@end deftypefn
10119
10120@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10121This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10122whose elements have the indicated @var{type}.  Assumes that it is already
10123known that a cookie is needed.  The default is
10124@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10125IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10126@end deftypefn
10127
10128@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10129This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10130array cookies.  The default is to return @code{false}.
10131@end deftypefn
10132
10133@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10134If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10135class @var{type} to be overruled.  Upon entry @var{import_export}
10136will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10137to be imported and 0 otherwise.  This function should return the
10138modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10139backend's targeted operating system.
10140@end deftypefn
10141
10142@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10143This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10144the address of the object created/destroyed.  The default is to return
10145@code{false}.
10146@end deftypefn
10147
10148@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10149This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10150which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10151table to be emitted) may be an inline function.  Under the standard
10152Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10153the function is not declared inline in the class definition.  Under
10154some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10155method.  The default is to return @code{true}.
10156@end deftypefn
10157
10158@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10159@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit.  No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified.  If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10160@end deftypefn
10161
10162@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10163This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10164similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10165external linkage.  If this hook returns false, then class data for
10166classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10167unit will not be COMDAT.
10168@end deftypefn
10169
10170@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10171This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10172the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10173be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10174@end deftypefn
10175
10176@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10177This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10178should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10179is in effect.  The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10180@end deftypefn
10181
10182@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10183This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10184in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10185destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10186shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10187unloaded. The default is to return false.
10188@end deftypefn
10189
10190@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10191@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined.  Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10192@end deftypefn
10193
10194@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10195Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10196@end deftypefn
10197
10198@node Named Address Spaces
10199@section Adding support for named address spaces
10200@cindex named address spaces
10201
10202The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10203standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10204support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10205processors to specify alternate address spaces.  You can configure a
10206GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10207address spaces other than the default address space.  These address
10208spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10209@code{const} type attributes.
10210
10211Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10212pointers to the generic address space.
10213
10214For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10215to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10216processor.  Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10217issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10218local processor memory address space.  Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10219address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10220@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10221always 32 bits).
10222
10223Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10224range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10225address space.
10226
10227To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10228the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine.  For example,
10229the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10230named address space #1:
10231@smallexample
10232#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10233c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10234@end smallexample
10235
10236@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10237Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10238@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10239The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10240generic address space only.
10241@end deftypefn
10242
10243@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10244Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10245@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10246The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10247generic address space only.
10248@end deftypefn
10249
10250@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10251Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10252with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}.  This target
10253hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10254except that it includes explicit named address space support.  The default
10255version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10256@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10257target hooks for the given address space.
10258@end deftypefn
10259
10260@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10261Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10262@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  The @var{strict}
10263parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10264finished.  This target hook is the same as the
10265@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10266explicit named address space support.
10267@end deftypefn
10268
10269@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10270Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10271with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  This target
10272hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10273except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10274@end deftypefn
10275
10276@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10277Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10278contained within the @var{superset} named address space.  Pointers to
10279a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10280will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10281arithmetic operations.  Pointers to a superset address space can be
10282converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10283@end deftypefn
10284
10285@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10286Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10287@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10288space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10289to a different named address space.  When this hook it called, it is
10290guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10291as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10292@end deftypefn
10293
10294@node Misc
10295@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10296@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10297
10298@c prevent bad page break with this line
10299Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10300
10301@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10302Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10303has conditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10304conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10305blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10306set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10307to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10308@end defmac
10309
10310@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10311Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10312has unconditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10313conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10314blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10315set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10316to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10317@end defmac
10318
10319@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10320An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
10321elements of a jump-table should have.
10322@end defmac
10323
10324@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10325Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10326when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
10327it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10328To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10329make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10330The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10331flags can be updated.
10332@end defmac
10333
10334@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10335Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10336should contain relative addresses.  You need not define this macro if
10337jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10338contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10339is in effect.
10340@end defmac
10341
10342@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10343This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10344is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10345The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10346five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
10347@end deftypefn
10348
10349@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10350Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10351statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests.  This is
10352advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10353of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10354targets that would require a loop.  By default, this macro returns
10355@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10356@code{false} otherwise.
10357@end defmac
10358
10359@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10360Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10361smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10362Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10363@end defmac
10364
10365@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10366Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10367memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10368bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10369zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10370of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10371insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10372@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10373
10374This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10375greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10376value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
10377@code{UNKNOWN}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10378define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10379
10380You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10381the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10382of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10383when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10384integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10385
10386You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10387mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10388@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10389is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10390@end defmac
10391
10392@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10393Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10394extends.
10395@end defmac
10396
10397@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10398Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10399point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10400unsigned one.
10401@end defmac
10402
10403@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10404When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10405divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10406the reciprocal.  This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10407that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10408of mode @var{mode}.  The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10409has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10410@end deftypefn
10411
10412@defmac MOVE_MAX
10413The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10414between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10415@end defmac
10416
10417@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10418The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10419between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
10420is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
10421constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10422at run-time.
10423@end defmac
10424
10425@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10426A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10427actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10428of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
10429this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10430a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10431truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
10432instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10433include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10434also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10435arguments to bit-field instructions.
10436
10437If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10438position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10439instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10440
10441However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10442only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10443bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10444such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10445the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10446
10447You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10448@end defmac
10449
10450@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10451@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10452This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10453deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10454@xref{shift patterns}.
10455
10456On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10457shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10458equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}.  If
10459this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10460otherwise it should return 0.  A return value of 0 indicates that no
10461particular behavior is guaranteed.
10462
10463Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10464@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10465that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10466
10467The default implementation of this function returns
10468@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10469and 0 otherwise.  This definition is always safe, but if
10470@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10471nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10472by overriding it.
10473@end deftypefn
10474
10475@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10476A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10477``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10478bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10479operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10480
10481On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10482
10483@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
10484@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
10485When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10486modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10487If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10488such cases may improve things.
10489@end defmac
10490
10491@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10492The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10493are always extended to a wider integral mode.  Return
10494@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10495sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}.  Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10496otherwise.  (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10497representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10498@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10499@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}.  Also no target extends
10500@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10501widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10502
10503Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10504value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10505as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10506@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10507
10508Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10509describe two related properties.  If you define
10510@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10511to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10512extension.
10513
10514In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10515@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10516@code{mode}.
10517@end deftypefn
10518
10519@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10520A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10521with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10522(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true.  This description must
10523apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10524comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10525
10526A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10527comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10528and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
10529which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10530true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10531operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10532@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10533@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
10534the compiler.
10535
10536If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10537generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
10538replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10539the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10540For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10541@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10542@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10543expression
10544
10545@smallexample
10546(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10547@end smallexample
10548
10549@noindent
10550can be converted to
10551
10552@smallexample
10553(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10554@end smallexample
10555
10556@noindent
10557where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10558tested into the sign bit.
10559
10560There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10561for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10562but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
10563are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10564perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10565comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10566
10567Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10568from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
10569choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10570to be used:
10571
10572@itemize @bullet
10573@item
10574Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10575@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
10576``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10577comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10578combine the normalization with other operations.
10579
10580@item
10581For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10582slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10583other machines.
10584
10585@item
10586As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10587exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10588others.
10589
10590@item
10591Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10592@end itemize
10593
10594Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10595@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10596instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10597those cases, e.g., one matching
10598
10599@smallexample
10600(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10601@end smallexample
10602
10603Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10604condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10605@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
10606machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
10607and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10608@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
10609@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10610find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10611
10612If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used.  You need
10613not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10614instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10615@end defmac
10616
10617@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10618A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10619returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10620Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10621floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
10622this macro.
10623@end defmac
10624
10625@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10626A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10627for vector comparisons.  The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10628mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode.  Define
10629this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10630return a vector result.  If there are no such operations, do not define
10631this macro.  Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10632@code{constm1_rtx}.  This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10633the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10634given mode.
10635@end defmac
10636
10637@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10638@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10639A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10640for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10641A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10642If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10643evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10644entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10645the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10646In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10647this value.
10648
10649If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10650@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10651
10652This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10653relies on a particular value to get correct results.  Otherwise it
10654is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10655to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10656
10657Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10658and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10659visible to the user.  Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10660to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10661breaking the API@.
10662@end defmac
10663
10664@defmac Pmode
10665An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
10666this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10667pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10668On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10669modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10670
10671The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10672@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10673@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10674to @code{Pmode}.
10675@end defmac
10676
10677@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10678An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10679being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most CISC machines,
10680where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10681@code{QImode}.  On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10682size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10683as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10684@end defmac
10685
10686@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10687In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10688constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
10689hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10690where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10691strict conformance to the C Standard.
10692
10693Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10694convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10695files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10696@end defmac
10697
10698@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10699Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10700This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10701C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10702@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10703@end defmac
10704
10705@findex #pragma
10706@findex pragma
10707@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10708Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10709If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10710@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10711for each pragma.  The macro may also do any
10712setup required for the pragmas.
10713
10714The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10715other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
10716definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10717
10718If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10719defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10720
10721Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
10722@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10723silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10724@end defmac
10725
10726@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10727@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10728
10729Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10730@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma.  The
10731@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10732pragma of the form
10733
10734@smallexample
10735#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10736@end smallexample
10737
10738@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10739@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
10740routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10741on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
10742@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
10743callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
10744a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.  Macro expansion occurs on the
10745arguments of pragmas registered with
10746@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10747pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10748
10749Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10750compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10751other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10752to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10753building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
10754variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10755target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
10756the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10757code that uses @code{pragma_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
10758rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10759how to build this object file.
10760@end deftypefun
10761
10762@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10763Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10764arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10765@end defmac
10766
10767@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10768True if @code{#pragma extern_prefix} is to be supported.
10769@end deftypevr
10770
10771@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10772If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10773the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10774This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10775@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10776@end defmac
10777
10778@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10779Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10780identifier names for the C family of languages.  0 means @samp{$} is
10781not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.  1 is the default;
10782there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10783@end defmac
10784
10785@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10786Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10787@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
10788G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
10789@samp{.} is used instead.
10790@end defmac
10791
10792@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10793Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10794@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
10795have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
10796are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10797@end defmac
10798
10799@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10800Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10801delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10802even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10803@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10804every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
10805or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10806you should define this macro.
10807
10808You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10809@end defmac
10810
10811@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10812Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10813delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10814even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10815@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
10816some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10817are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10818define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10819instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10820slot of @var{insn}.
10821
10822You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10823@end defmac
10824
10825@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10826Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10827global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10828symbols in another translation unit without user intervention.  For
10829instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10830from shared libraries (DLLs).
10831
10832You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10833@end defmac
10834
10835@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10836This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10837any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10838It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10839clobber.  The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10840corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10841clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm.  You can use
10842@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10843for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10844@end deftypefn
10845
10846@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10847Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10848in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10849@samp{""} if the target does not have a
10850separate math library.
10851
10852You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10853@end defmac
10854
10855@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10856Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10857specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10858
10859You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10860is wrong.
10861@end defmac
10862
10863@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10864Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10865functions, access, mkdir and  file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10866Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10867to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10868if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10869for cross-profiling.
10870@end defmac
10871
10872@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10873
10874A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10875conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
10876@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
108771 if it does use cc0.
10878@end defmac
10879
10880@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10881Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10882conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10883@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10884contains information about the currently processed blocks.  @var{true_expr}
10885and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10886then-block and the else-block, respectively.  Set either @var{true_expr} or
10887@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10888@end defmac
10889
10890@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10891Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10892if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10893@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10894being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10895@end defmac
10896
10897@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10898A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10899be converted to conditional execution format.  @var{ce_info} points to
10900a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10901about the currently processed blocks.
10902@end defmac
10903
10904@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10905A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10906converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
10907can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10908to by @var{ce_info}.
10909@end defmac
10910
10911@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10912A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10913converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
10914can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10915to by @var{ce_info}.
10916@end defmac
10917
10918@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10919A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10920structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10921@end defmac
10922
10923@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10924If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10925added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure.  These should be initialized
10926by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10927@end defmac
10928
10929@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10930If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10931instruction stream.  The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10932just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10933
10934The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target.  Some use
10935it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10936laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10937Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10938
10939You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do.  The default
10940definition is null.
10941@end deftypefn
10942
10943@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10944Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10945that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
10946necessary setup.
10947
10948Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10949instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10950they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10951instructions or prefetch instructions).
10952
10953To create a built-in function, call the function
10954@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10955which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
10956up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10957only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10958@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10959@end deftypefn
10960
10961@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10962Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10963that need to be defined.  It should be a function that returns the
10964builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10965If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10966if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10967If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10968@code{error_mark_node}.
10969@end deftypefn
10970
10971@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10972
10973Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10974@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
10975function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10976convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10977@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10978@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10979ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
10980built-in function.
10981@end deftypefn
10982
10983@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10984Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10985was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  This is done
10986@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10987implement a crude form of function overloading.  @var{fndecl} is the
10988declaration of the built-in function.  @var{arglist} is the list of
10989arguments passed to the built-in function.  The result is a
10990complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10991another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10992@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10993@end deftypefn
10994
10995@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10996Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10997@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10998built-in function.  @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10999the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11000The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
11001call's result.  If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11002@end deftypefn
11003
11004@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
11005
11006Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11007low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11008could not be applied.
11009
11010Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11011instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11012the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11013By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11014loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11015@end deftypefn
11016
11017@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
11018
11019Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
11020Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
11021@var{branch2} is possible.
11022
11023On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
11024filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
11025may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
11026@end defmac
11027
11028@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11029This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11030Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11031PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@.  @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11032of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11033@end deftypefn
11034
11035@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11036
11037When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11038register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11039to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11040it has been saved into can be used.  @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11041is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11042that had its initial value copied by using
11043@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11044Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11045to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11046the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11047@code{MEM}.
11048If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11049it might decide to use another register anyways.
11050You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
11051that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
11052register in question will not be clobbered.
11053The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11054allocation.
11055@end deftypefn
11056
11057@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11058This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11059@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap.  Targets can use
11060this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11061@code{unspec_volatile} operations.  You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11062to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11063passed along.
11064@end deftypefn
11065
11066@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11067The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11068context (@code{cfun}).  You can define this function if
11069the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11070per-function basis.  For example, it may be used to implement function
11071attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11072The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11073and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11074and is returning to processing at the top level.
11075The default hook function does nothing.
11076
11077GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11078some parts of the back end.  The hook function is not invoked in this
11079situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11080or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11081@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11082outside of any function scope.
11083@end deftypefn
11084
11085@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11086Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11087files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11088use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11089@end defmac
11090
11091@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11092Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11093automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
11094do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11095executable files.
11096@end defmac
11097
11098@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11099If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11100specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11101Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11102object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11103lists.
11104@end defmac
11105
11106@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11107Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11108method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11109must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11110For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11111the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11112defined as this expression:
11113
11114@smallexample
11115build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11116                              build_tree_list
11117                              (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11118                               NULL))
11119@end smallexample
11120@end defmac
11121
11122@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11123This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11124instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
11125every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11126reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11127
11128@smallexample
11129static bool
11130cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11131@{
11132  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11133@}
11134@end smallexample
11135@end deftypefn
11136
11137@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11138This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11139optimizations should be applied.  All registers in this class should be
11140usable interchangeably.  After reload, registers in this class will be
11141re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11142to inter-block scheduling.
11143@end deftypefn
11144
11145@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11146Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11147registers
11148that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11149returns true, they will be included.  The target code must than make sure
11150that all target registers in the class returned by
11151@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11152saved.  @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11153epilogues have already been generated.  Note, even if you only return
11154true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11155to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11156to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11157@end deftypefn
11158
11159@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11160This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11161This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11162modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11163@end deftypefn
11164
11165@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11166This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11167should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11168the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11169the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11170is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11171number of memory accesses.
11172@end deftypefn
11173
11174@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11175If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11176that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11177that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11178constant inline.  When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11179more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11180system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11181The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11182@end defmac
11183
11184@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11185This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11186target.  The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11187are present.  The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11188The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11189@end deftypefn
11190
11191@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11192This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11193target before any standard headers.  The parameter @var{stdinc}
11194indicates if normal include files are present.  The parameter
11195@var{sysroot} is the system root directory.  The parameter
11196@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11197@end deftypefn
11198
11199@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11200This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11201The parameter @var{path} is the include to register.  On Darwin
11202systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11203that are different from @option{-I}.
11204@end deftypefn
11205
11206@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11207This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11208for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11209@code{false} otherwise.  By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11210functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11211@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11212@end defmac
11213
11214@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11215If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11216target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11217option.  The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11218@end defmac
11219
11220@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11221If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11222@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11223@end defmac
11224
11225@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11226If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11227target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11228default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11229@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11230@end defmac
11231
11232@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11233If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11234@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11235@end defmac
11236
11237@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11238If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11239routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11240and scanf formatter settings.
11241@end defmac
11242
11243@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11244If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11245guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11246main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11247important, an explicit memory barrier must be used.  This is true of
11248many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11249``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11250and ia64.  The default is @code{false}.
11251@end deftypevr
11252
11253@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11254If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11255illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11256with prototype @var{typelist}.
11257@end deftypefn
11258
11259@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11260If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11261invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11262if validity should be determined by the front end.
11263@end deftypefn
11264
11265@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11266If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11267invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11268@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11269if validity should be determined by the front end.
11270@end deftypefn
11271
11272@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11273If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11274invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11275and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11276the front end.
11277@end deftypefn
11278
11279@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11280If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11281invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11282or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11283the front end.  This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11284@end deftypefn
11285
11286@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11287If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11288invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11289or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11290the front end.  This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11291@end deftypefn
11292
11293@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11294If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11295@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11296analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11297front end's normal promotion rules.  This hook is useful when there are
11298target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11299This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11300@end deftypefn
11301
11302@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11303If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11304@var{type}.  It should return the converted expression,
11305or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11306This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11307conversion rules.
11308This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11309@end deftypefn
11310
11311@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11312This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11313classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11314SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11315@end defmac
11316
11317@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11318This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11319NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11320@end defmac
11321
11322@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11323Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11324to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11325call stack unwinding.  It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11326and the associated definitions of those functions.
11327@end defmac
11328
11329@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11330Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11331necessary.
11332@end deftypefn
11333
11334@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11335This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11336different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11337argument list due to stack realignment.  Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11338is needed.
11339@end deftypefn
11340
11341@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11342When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11343arguments should be allocated to stack slots.  Normally, GCC allocates
11344stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11345debugging easier.  However, when a function is declared with
11346@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11347cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11348to the stack.  Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11349false for naked functions.  The default implementation always returns true.
11350@end deftypefn
11351
11352@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11353On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11354a constant.  If there is another constant already in a register that
11355is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11356is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11357subtraction.  We accomplish this through CSE.  Besides the value of
11358the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11359available expressions.  These are then queried when encountering new
11360constants.  The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11361down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11362@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11363accepted by immediate-add plus one.  We currently assume that the
11364value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2.  For example, on
11365MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11366@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}.  The default value
11367is zero, which disables this optimization.  @end deftypevr
11368
11369@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11370This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11371@end deftypevr
11372